blob: c2e8023fd25dc293e1d35f45d166f70d9cdee15d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Christopher Faulet9f971552022-05-13 17:13:48 +02006 2022/05/13
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013111. Address formats
13211.1. Address family prefixes
13311.2. Socket type prefixes
13411.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
1361. Quick reminder about HTTP
137----------------------------
138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100139When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
141on almost anything found in the contents.
142
143However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
144formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
145correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
146
147
1481.1. The HTTP transaction model
149-------------------------------
150
151The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100152to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100153from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
154connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155will involve a new connection :
156
157 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
158
159In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
160establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
161by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
162length.
163
164Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
165to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
166however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
167response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
168header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
169
170 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
171
172Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
173power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
174but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200175a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100177Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
179second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
180page :
181
182 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
183
184This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
185latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
186correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
187the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100188server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
191time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
192are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
193parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
194carry the stream identifier.
195
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
197connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
198leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100199start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
200processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
201waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200202
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
205 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100206 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200208 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211
2121.2. HTTP request
213-----------------
214
215First, let's consider this HTTP request :
216
217 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
220 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
221 3 User-agent: my small browser
222 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
223 5 Accept: image/png
224
225
2261.2.1. The Request line
227-----------------------
228
229Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
230
231 - a METHOD : GET
232 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
234
235All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
236which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
237followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
238is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
239desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
240the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
241
242The URI itself can have several forms :
243
244 - A "relative URI" :
245
246 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
247
248 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
249 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
250
251 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
252
253 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
254
255 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
256 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
257 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
258 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
259 must accept this form too.
260
261 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
262 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
263 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200265 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
266 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
267 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
268 other protocols too.
269
270In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
271mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
272on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
273It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
274specific to the language, framework or application in use.
275
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100277assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200295as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
296normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
297representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
298HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400339over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400383 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200388 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
390 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
391 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
392
393The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3944.2).
395
396
3971.3.2. The response headers
398---------------------------
399
400Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
401the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
402details.
403
404
4052. Configuring HAProxy
406----------------------
407
4082.1. Configuration file format
409------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
411HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
412
413 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700415 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
419a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100420
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100421 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
422
423 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
424
425 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
426 tab characters
427
428 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
429 keyword sequences listed in this document
430
431 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
432 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
433 parts of the configuration, or expressions
434
435 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
436 are supported
437
438 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
439 section
440
441This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
442generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
443figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
444
445First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
446the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
447a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
448word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
449follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
450the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
451the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
452the parts that need to be addressed.
453
454A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
455requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
456extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
457the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
458section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
459section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
460not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
461
462A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
463each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
464a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
465start a new one.
466
467Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
468that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
469applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
470"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
471processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
472ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
473which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
474In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
475of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
476identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
477such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4782, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
479
480 listen foo
481 bind :80
482
483 listen bar
484 bind :81
485
486Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
487spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
488of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
489following configurations are strictly equivalent:
490
491 global#this is the global section
492 daemon#daemonize
493 frontend foo
494 mode http # or tcp
495
496and:
497
498 global
499 daemon
500
501 # this is the public web frontend
502 frontend foo
503 mode http
504
505The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
506new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
507other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
508section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
509section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
510at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
511
512Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
513are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
514editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
515support automatic indent.
516
517In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
518positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
519modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
520anymore, and is not recommended.
521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200522
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005232.2. Quoting and escaping
524-------------------------
525
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100526In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
527that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
528possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
529in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
530('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200531
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100532This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
533very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
534the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
535also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
536delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
537word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
538remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
541(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
542
543Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
544backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200545
546 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
547 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
548 \\ to use a backslash
549 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
550 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
551
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100552In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
553C-language representation:
554
555 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
556 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
557 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
558 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
559
560Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
561or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
562of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
566 # hash as a comment start
567
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100568Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
569evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
570dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
571backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
574character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
575is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
578entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
579name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
580represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
581hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200582
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100583 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
584 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
585 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
586 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
587 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
588 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
589 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
590 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
591 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
592 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
593 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594
595 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
599 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
602
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
604necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
605by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
606they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
607escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
608characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
609case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
610if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
611own quotes.
612
613The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600614quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500615not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
617
618Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
619arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
620
621 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
622 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
623
624Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
625"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
626cannot write:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629
630because we would like the string to cut like this:
631
632 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
633 |---------|----|-|
634 arg1 _/ / /
635 arg2 __________/ /
636 arg3 ______________/
637
638but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
639parenthesis then garbage:
640
641 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
642 |--------|--------|
643 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
644 trailing garbage _________/
645
646The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
647quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
648processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
649this word:
650
651 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
652 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
653 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
654
655So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
656still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
657the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
658the second level:
659
660 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
661 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
662 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
663 |---------||----|-|
664 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
665 arg2=blah ___________/ /
666 arg3=g _______________/
667
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500668Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100669double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
670
671 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
674 |---------||----|-|
675 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
676 arg2 ___________/ /
677 arg3 _______________/
678
679When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
680appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
681string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
682thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
683
684 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
685 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
686 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
687 |-------------| |-----||-|
688 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
689 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
690 arg3 ______________________/
691
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400692Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600693that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
695single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
696level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
697
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600698Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
699if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
700or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
701
702 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
705
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100706When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
707double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600708and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100709a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
710a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
711the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
712regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
713around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
714more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200715
716
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007172.3. Environment variables
718--------------------------
719
720HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
721interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
722configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
723optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
724shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200725underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
726list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
727arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
728before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200729
730 Example:
731
732 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
733
734 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
735
736 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
737
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200738Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
739file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200740
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200741* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
742 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
743
744* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
745 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
746 directory.
747
748* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
749
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500750* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200751 processes, separated by semicolons.
752
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500753* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200754 CLI, separated by semicolons.
755
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200756In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
757regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
758only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
759
760* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
761
762* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
763 starting at one.
764
765* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
766 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
767 first section.
768
769These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
770if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
771section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
772"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
773proxies.
774
775This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
776logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
777to name some config objects like servers for example.
778
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200780
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100781
7822.4. Conditional blocks
783-----------------------
784
785It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
786some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
787ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
788configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
789versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
790preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
791text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
792lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
793switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
794are defined to form conditional blocks:
795
796 - .if <condition>
797 - .elif <condition>
798 - .else
799 - .endif
800
801The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
802as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
803matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
804there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
805only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
806".elif" of a block.
807
808Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
809ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
810as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
811
812The conditions are currently limited to:
813
814 - an empty string, always returns "false"
815 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
816 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200817 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
818
819The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
820
821 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
822 exists, regardless of its contents
823
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200824 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
825 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
826 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
827
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200828 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
829 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
830
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200831 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
832 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
833 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
834 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
835
836 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200841Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200843 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
844 listen mwcli_px
845 bind :1111
846 ...
847 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100848
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200849 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
850 bind :80
851 .endif
852
853 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200854 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200855 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200856 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200857 .endif
858
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200859 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
860 profiling.memory on
861 .endif
862
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200863Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100864
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200865 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
867 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
868 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
869
870Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
871"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
872fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
873provide advice to the user.
874
875Example:
876
877 .if "${A}"
878 .if "${B}"
879 .notice "A=1, B=1"
880 .elif "${C}"
881 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
882 .elif "${D}"
883 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
884 .else
885 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
886 .endif
887 .else
888 .notice "A=0"
889 .endif
890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
892 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
893
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100894
8952.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200896----------------
897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100898Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100899values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
900otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
901numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
902for every keyword. Supported units are :
903
904 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
905 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
906 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
907 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
908 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
909 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
910
911
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009122.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200913-------------
914
915 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
916 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
917 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
918 global
919 daemon
920 maxconn 256
921
922 defaults
923 mode http
924 timeout connect 5000ms
925 timeout client 50000ms
926 timeout server 50000ms
927
928 frontend http-in
929 bind *:80
930 default_backend servers
931
932 backend servers
933 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
934
935
936 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
937 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
938 global
939 daemon
940 maxconn 256
941
942 defaults
943 mode http
944 timeout connect 5000ms
945 timeout client 50000ms
946 timeout server 50000ms
947
948 listen http-in
949 bind *:80
950 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
951
952
953Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
954
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100955 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200956
957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009583. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959--------------------
960
961Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
962are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
963of them have command-line equivalents.
964
965The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
966
967 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200968 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200970 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200971 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200973 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200974 - description
975 - deviceatlas-json-file
976 - deviceatlas-log-level
977 - deviceatlas-separator
978 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200979 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900980 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200981 - gid
982 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100983 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200984 - h1-case-adjust
985 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100986 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100987 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100988 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +0200989 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200990 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200991 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200992 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100993 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200994 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100995 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100996 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200997 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200999 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001001 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001003 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001004 - presetenv
1005 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - uid
1007 - ulimit-n
1008 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001009 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001010 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001011 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001012 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001013 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001014 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001015 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001016 - ssl-default-bind-options
1017 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001018 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - ssl-default-server-options
1020 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001021 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001022 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001023 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001024 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001025 - 51degrees-data-file
1026 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001027 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001028 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001029 - wurfl-data-file
1030 - wurfl-information-list
1031 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001032 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001033 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001036 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001037 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001039 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001040 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001041 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001042 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001043 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001044 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001045 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001046 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001047 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048 - noepoll
1049 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001050 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001052 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001053 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001054 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001055 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001056 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001057 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001058 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001059 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001060 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001061 - tune.buffers.limit
1062 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001063 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001064 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001065 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001066 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001067 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001068 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001069 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001070 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001071 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001072 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001073 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001074 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001075 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001076 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001077 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1078 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001079 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001080 - tune.maxaccept
1081 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001082 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001083 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001084 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001085 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1086 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001087 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1088 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001089 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001090 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001091 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001092 - tune.sndbuf.client
1093 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001094 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001095 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001096 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001097 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001098 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001099 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001100 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001101 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001102 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001103 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001104 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1105 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1106 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001107 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1108 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001112 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
1114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116------------------------------------
1117
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001118ca-base <dir>
1119 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001120 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1121 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1122 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001123
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124chroot <jail dir>
1125 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1126 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1127 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1128 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1129 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001130 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001131
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001132cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1133 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1134 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1135 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1136 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1137 set. These sets have the format
1138
1139 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1140
1141 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001142 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001143 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1144 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001145 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1146 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001147 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1148 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1149 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1150 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1151 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1152 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1153 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1154 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1155 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1156 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001157
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001158 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1159 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1160 on the machine's word size.
1161
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001162 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001163 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1164 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1165 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1166 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1167 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1168 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001169
1170 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001171 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1172
1173 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1174 # first 4 CPUs
1175
1176 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1177 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1178 # word size.
1179
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001180 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001181 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001182 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1183 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1184 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1185
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001186 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1187 # and so on.
1188 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1189 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1190 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001192 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001193 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1194 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1195 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1196
1197 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1198 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1199 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1200
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1202 # and a thread range.
1203 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1204 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1205 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1206
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001207crt-base <dir>
1208 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001209 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1210 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001211
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001212daemon
1213 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1214 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001215 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1216 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001217
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001218default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001219 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001220 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1221 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1222 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1223 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1224 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1225 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1226 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1227 not start with a slash ('/'):
1228 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1229 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1230
1231 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1232 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1233 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1234 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1235 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1236 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1237 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1238 each of them.
1239
1240 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1241 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1242 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1243 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1244 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1245 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1246 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1247 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1248
1249 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1250 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001251 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001252 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1253 made easily relocatable.
1254
1255 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1256 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1257 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1258 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1259 consistent across all configuration files.
1260
1261 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1262 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1263 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1264 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1265 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1266 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1267 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1268 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1269
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001270deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1271 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001272 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001273
1274deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001275 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001276 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1277
1278deviceatlas-separator <char>
1279 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1280 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1281
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001282deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001283 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1284 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1285 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001286
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001287expose-experimental-directives
1288 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1289 the config file will be rejected.
1290
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001291external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001292 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1293 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001294 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1295 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1296 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1297 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1298 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001300gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001301 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001302 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1303 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001304 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001305 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001307
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001308group <group name>
1309 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1310 See also "gid" and "user".
1311
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001312hard-stop-after <time>
1313 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1314
1315 Arguments :
1316 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1317 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1318 SIGUSR1 signal.
1319
1320 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1321 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1322 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1323
1324 Example:
1325 global
1326 hard-stop-after 30s
1327
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001328h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1329 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1330 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1331 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1332 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001333 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001334 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1335 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1336 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1337 specified in a proxy.
1338
1339 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1340 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1341 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1342 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1343 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1344 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1345 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1346
1347 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1348 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1349 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1350 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1351 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1352
1353 Example:
1354 global
1355 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1356
1357 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1358 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1359
1360h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1361 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1362 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1363 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1364 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1365 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1366 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1367 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1368 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1369
1370 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1371 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1372 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1373
1374 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1375 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1376
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001377insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001378 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001379 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1380 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1381 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1382 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1383 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1384 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1385 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001386 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001387 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1388 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1389 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1390 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1391 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1392 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1393 disable it.
1394
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001395insecure-setuid-wanted
1396 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1397 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1398 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1399 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001400 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001401 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001402 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001403 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1404 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001405 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001406 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1407 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1408 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1409 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1410
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001411issuers-chain-path <dir>
1412 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1413 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1414 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001415 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001416 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1417 "issuers-chain-path".
1418 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1419 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1420 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1421 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1422 will share the chain in memory.
1423
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001424h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1425 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1426 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1427 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1428 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1429 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1430 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1431 the keyword with "no'.
1432
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001433localpeer <name>
1434 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1435 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1436 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1437 the configuration parsing.
1438
1439 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1440 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1441
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001442log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001443 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001444 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001445 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001446 configured with "log global".
1447
1448 <address> can be one of:
1449
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001450 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001451 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1452 port).
1453
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001454 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1455 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1456 port).
1457
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001458 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001459 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1460 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001461 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001462
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001463 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1464 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1465 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1466 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1467 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1468 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1469 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1470 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1471 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1472 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001473 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001474 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1475 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1476 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001477 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1478 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001479
1480 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1481 "fd@2", see above.
1482
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001483 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1484 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1485 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1486 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1487 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1488
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001489 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1490 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001491
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001492 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1493 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1494 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1495 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1496 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1497 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1498 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1499 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1500 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1501 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001502 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1503 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001504
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001505 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1506 one of the following :
1507
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001508 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1509 field is stripped. This is the default.
1510 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1511 rfc3164.
1512
1513 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001514 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1515
1516 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1517 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1518
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001519 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1520 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1521 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1522 designed to be used with a local log server.
1523
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001524 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1525 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1526 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1527 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1528 logger consumes.
1529
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001530 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1531 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1532 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1533 used with a local log server.
1534
1535 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1536 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1537 designed to be used with a local log server.
1538
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001539 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1540 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1541 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1542 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1543
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001544 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1545 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1546 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1547 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1548 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1549
1550 <sample_size>
1551 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1552 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1553 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1554 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1555 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1556
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001557 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001558
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001559 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1560 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1561 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1562
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001563 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1564 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1565 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1566 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567
1568 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001569 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1570 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1571 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1572 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1573 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1574 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001575
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001576 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001577
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001578log-send-hostname [<string>]
1579 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1580 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1581 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1582 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1583 the logs.
1584
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001585log-tag <string>
1586 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1587 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1588 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001589 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001590
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001591lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001592 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1593 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1594 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1595 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1596 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1597 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001598 used multiple times.
1599
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001600lua-load-per-thread <file>
1601 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1602 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1603 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1604 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1605 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1606 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1607 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1608 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1609 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1610 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1611 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1612 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1613 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1614 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1615 times.
1616
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001617lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1618 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1619 variable.
1620 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1621 to "path".
1622
1623 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1624 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1625 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1626 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1627 will be checked earlier.
1628
1629 As an example by specifying the following path:
1630
1631 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1632 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1633
1634 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1635 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1636 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1637 paths if that does not exist either.
1638
1639 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1640 documentation.
1641
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001642master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001643 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1644 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1645 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001646 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001647 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1648 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001649 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1650 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1651 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1652 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1653 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001654
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001655 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001656
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001657mworker-max-reloads <number>
1658 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001659 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001660 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1661 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1662 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1663
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001664nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001665 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1666 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1667 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001668 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1669 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001670 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1671 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1672 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001673
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001674nbthread <number>
1675 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001676 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001677 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1678 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1679 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1680 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001681 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1682 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1683 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1684 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1685 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1686 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1687 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001688
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001689numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001690 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001691 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1692 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1693 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1694 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1695 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1696 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1697 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1698 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001700pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001701 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1702 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1703 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1704 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001705
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001706pp2-never-send-local
1707 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1708 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1709 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1710 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1711 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1712 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1713 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1714 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1715 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1716 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1717 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1718
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001719presetenv <name> <value>
1720 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1721 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1722 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1723 and "unsetenv".
1724
1725resetenv [<name> ...]
1726 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1727 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1728 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1729 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1730 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1731 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1732 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1733 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1734
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001735stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001736 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1737 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1738 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1739 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1740 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1741 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001742 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001743 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1744 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1745 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1746 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001747
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001748server-state-base <directory>
1749 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001750 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1751 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001752
1753server-state-file <file>
1754 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1755 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1756 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1757 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1758 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1759 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1760 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1761 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001762 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1763 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001764
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001765set-var <var-name> <expr>
1766 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1767 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1768 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1769 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1770 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1771 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1772 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1773 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1774 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1775
1776 Example:
1777 global
1778 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1779 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1780 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1781
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001782setenv <name> <value>
1783 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1784 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1785 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1786 and "unsetenv".
1787
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001788set-dumpable
1789 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001790 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1791 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1792 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1793 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1794 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1795 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1796 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1797 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1798 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1799 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1800 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1801 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1802 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1803 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1804 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001805 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001806 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001807
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001808ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1810 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001811 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001812 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001813 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1814 information and recommendations see e.g.
1815 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1816 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1817 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1818 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001819
1820ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1822 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1823 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1824 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1825 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001826 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1827 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1828 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001829 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001830
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001831ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1833 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1834 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1835 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1836 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1837
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001838ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1840 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1841 keyword to see available options.
1842
1843 Example:
1844 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001845 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001846
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001847ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1849 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001850 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001851 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001852 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1853 information and recommendations see e.g.
1854 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1855 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1856 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1857 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1858 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001859
1860ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1862 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1863 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1864 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1865 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001866 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1867 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1868 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1869 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001870
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001871ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1873 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1874 keyword to see available options.
1875
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001876ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1878 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1879 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001880 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001881 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001882 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1883 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1884 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1885 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001886 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1887 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1888 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1889
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001890ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1891 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1892 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001893 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001894 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001895 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1896
1897 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001898
1899 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1900 and won't try to remove them.
1901
1902 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1903
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001904ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001905 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001906 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1907 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1908 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001909
1910 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1911 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1912 optimize the startup time.
1913
1914 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1915 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1916 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1917
1918 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001919 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001920
1921 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001922 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1923 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001924
1925 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1926 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1927 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1928 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1929 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001930 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001931
1932 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001933 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001934 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1935 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1936 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1937 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1938 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001939 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001940
1941 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1942
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001943 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001944 a cert bundle.
1945
1946 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1947 separately in several "crt".
1948
1949 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1950 since files are loading separately.
1951
1952 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1953 required to commit them.
1954
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001955 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001956 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001957
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001958 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1959 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1960 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001961
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001962 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1963 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1964 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001965
1966 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001967 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1968 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001969
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001970 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1971 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1972
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001973 The default behavior is "all".
1974
1975 Example:
1976 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1977 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1978 ssl-load-extra-files none
1979
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001980 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1981 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001982
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001983ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1984 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1985 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1986 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1987
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001988ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001989 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001990 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1991 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1992 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1993 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1994 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1995 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001996 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001997
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001998stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1999 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2000 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2001 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002002 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002003 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002004
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002005 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2006 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2007 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002008
2009stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2010 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2011 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002012 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002013
2014stats maxconn <connections>
2015 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2016 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2017
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002018uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002019 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002020 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2021 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2022 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2023
2024ulimit-n <number>
2025 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2026 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2027 option.
2028
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002029unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2030 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2031
2032 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2033 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2034 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2035 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2036 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002037 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002038 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2039 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2040 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2041 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2042
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002043unsetenv [<name> ...]
2044 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2045 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2046 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2047 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2048 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2049 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2050 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2051
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002052user <user name>
2053 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2054 See also "uid" and "group".
2055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002056node <name>
2057 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2058
2059 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2060 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2061 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2062 traffic.
2063
2064description <text>
2065 Add a text that describes the instance.
2066
2067 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2068 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2069 "<" and ">" characters.
2070
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100207151degrees-data-file <file path>
2072 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002074
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002075 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002076 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2077
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000207851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002079 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2080 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2081 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2082
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002084 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2085
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200208651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002087 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2088 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2089
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002090 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002091 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2092
209351degrees-cache-size <number>
2094 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2095 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2096 By default, this cache is disabled.
2097
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002098 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002099 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2100
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002101wurfl-data-file <file path>
2102 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2103 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2104
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002105 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002106 with USE_WURFL=1.
2107
2108wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2109 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2110 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2111 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2112
2113 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2114
2115 Valid WURFL properties are:
2116 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2117
2118 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2119 device.
2120
2121 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2122 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2123
2124 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2125 particular web request.
2126
2127 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2128 used Libwurfl API version.
2129
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002130 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2131 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2132
2133 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2134 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2135
2136 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2137
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002138 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002139 with USE_WURFL=1.
2140
2141wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2142 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2143 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2144
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002146 with USE_WURFL=1.
2147
2148wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2149 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2150 thus before the chroot.
2151
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002152 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002153 with USE_WURFL=1.
2154
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002155wurfl-cache-size <size>
2156 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2157 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002158 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002159 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002160
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002161 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002162 with USE_WURFL=1.
2163
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002164strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002165 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002166 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2167 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002168 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002169 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021713.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002172-----------------------
2173
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002174busy-polling
2175 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2176 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2177 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2178 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2179 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2180 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2181 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2182 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2183 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2184 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2185 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2186 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2187 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2188 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2189 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2190 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2191 "poll" pollers.
2192
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002193 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2194 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2195 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2196
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002197max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002198 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002199 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2200 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2201 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2202 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2203 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2204 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2205 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2206
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002207maxconn <number>
2208 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2209 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2210 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002211 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2212 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2213 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2214 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002215 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2216 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2217 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2218 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2219 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2220 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002221
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002222maxconnrate <number>
2223 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2224 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2225 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2226 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2227 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2228 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2229 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2230 fairness.
2231
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002232maxcomprate <number>
2233 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002234 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002235 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2236 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2237 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002238 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002239 default value.
2240
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002241maxcompcpuusage <number>
2242 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2243 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2244 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002245 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. In
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002246 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2247 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2248 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2249 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2250
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002251maxpipes <number>
2252 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2253 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2254 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2255 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2256 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2257 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2258
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002259maxsessrate <number>
2260 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2261 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2262 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2263 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2264 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2265 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2266 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2267 fairness.
2268
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002269maxsslconn <number>
2270 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2271 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2272 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2273 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2274 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2275 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2276 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002277 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2278 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2279 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2280 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002281 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002282 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2283 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002284
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002285maxsslrate <number>
2286 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2287 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2288 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2289 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2290 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2291 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2292 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2293 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2294 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2295 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2296
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002297maxzlibmem <number>
2298 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2299 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2300 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002301 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2302 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2303 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2304
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002305no-memory-trimming
2306 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2307 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2308 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2309 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2310 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2311 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2312 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2313 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2314 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2315 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2316 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2317 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2318 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2319 not suffer from such a problem.
2320
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002321noepoll
2322 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2323 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002324 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002325
2326nokqueue
2327 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2328 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2329 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2330
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002331noevports
2332 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2333 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2334 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2335 also "nopoll".
2336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002337nopoll
2338 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2339 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002340 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002341 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2342 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002343
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002344nosplice
2345 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002346 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002347 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002348 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002349 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2350 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2351 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2352 "option splice-response".
2353
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002354nogetaddrinfo
2355 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2356 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2357
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002358noreuseport
2359 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2360 command line argument "-dR".
2361
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002362profiling.memory { on | off }
2363 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2364 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2365 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2366 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2367 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2368 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2369 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2370 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2371 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2372
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002373profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2374 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2375 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2376 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2377 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002378 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002379 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2380 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2381 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2382 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2383
2384 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2385 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2386 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2387 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2388 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002389 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2390 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2391 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2392 CLI.
2393
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002394spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002395 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2396 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2397 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2398 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2399 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2400 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002401
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002402ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002403 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002404 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002405 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002406 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002407 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2408 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2409 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002410 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2411 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002412 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2413 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2414 openssl configuration file uses:
2415 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2416
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002417ssl-mode-async
2418 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002419 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002420 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2421 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002422 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002423 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002424 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002425
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002426tune.buffers.limit <number>
2427 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2428 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2429 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2430 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2431 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002432 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002433 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2434 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2435 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2436 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2437 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2438 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2439 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2440 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002441 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002442
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002443tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2444 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2445 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2446 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002447 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002448
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002449tune.bufsize <number>
2450 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2451 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2452 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2453 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2454 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2455 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2456 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002457 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2458 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002459 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002460 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002461 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002462 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2463 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002464
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002465tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2466 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002467
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002468tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2469 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2470 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2471 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2472 this value. The default value is 1.
2473
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002474tune.fail-alloc
2475 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2476 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2477 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2478 gracefully.
2479
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002480tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2481 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2482 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2483 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2484 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2485 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2486
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002487tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2488 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2489 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2490 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2491 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2492 change it.
2493
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002494tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2495 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002496 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002497 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002498 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2499 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2500 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2501 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2502 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2503
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002504tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2505 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2506 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2507 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2508 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2509 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002510 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002511 recommended not to change this value.
2512
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002513tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002514 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002515 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002516 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002517 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2518 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2519 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2520 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2521
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002522tune.http.cookielen <number>
2523 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2524 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2525 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2526 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2527 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2528 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2529 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2530 to change this value.
2531
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002532tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002533 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2534 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002535 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002536 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002537 configuration directives too.
2538 The default value is 1024.
2539
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002540tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2541 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2542 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2543 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2544 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2545 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2546 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002547 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2548 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2549 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002550
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002551tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2552 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2553 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2554 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2555 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2556 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2557 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002558 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2559 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2560 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2561 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2562 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002563
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002564tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002565 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002566 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2567 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2568 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2569 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002570 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002571 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002572 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002573 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2574
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002575tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2576 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2577 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2578 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2579 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2580 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2581 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2582 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2583 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2584 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2585
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002586tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2587 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002588 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002589 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2590 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002591 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002592 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2593 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2594
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002595tune.lua.maxmem
2596 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2597 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2598 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2599 memory.
2600
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002601tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2602 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002603 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2604 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002605 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002606
2607tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2608 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2609 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2610 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2611 check servers.
2612
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002613tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2614 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2615 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2616 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002617 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002618
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002619tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002620 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2621 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002622 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2623 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2624 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2625 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2626 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2627 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2628 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2629 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2630 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002631
2632tune.maxpollevents <number>
2633 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2634 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2635 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2636 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2637 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2638
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002639tune.maxrewrite <number>
2640 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2641 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2642 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2643 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2644 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2645 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2646 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2647 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2648 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2649 bufsize.
2650
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002651tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2652 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2653 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2654 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2655 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2656 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2657 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2658 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2659 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2660 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002661 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2662 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002663 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2664 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2665 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2666 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2667 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2668 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2669 setting this parameter to 0.
2670
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002671tune.pipesize <number>
2672 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2673 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2674 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2675 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2676 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2677 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2678
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002679tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2680 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002681 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002682 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2683 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2684 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2685 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002686 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002687
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002688tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2689 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002690 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002691 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2692 default is 20.
2693
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002694tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2695tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2696 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2697 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2698 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002699 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002700 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002701 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2702 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2703
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002704tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002705 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002706 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2707 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2708 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2709 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2710
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002711tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002712 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002713 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2714 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2715 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2716 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2717 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2718 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2719 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002720
2721tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2722 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002723 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002724 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2725 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2726 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2727 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2728 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2729 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2730 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002731
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002732tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2733tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2734 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2735 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2736 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002737 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002738 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002739 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2740 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2741 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2742 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002743 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002744
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002745tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002746 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002747 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2748 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2749 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2750 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2751 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2752 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2753 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2754 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2755 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2756 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2757 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002758
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002759tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002760 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002761 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2762 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2763 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2764 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2765 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2766
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002767tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2768 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2769 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2770 performances. This is disabled by default.
2771
2772 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2773 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2774
2775 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2776
2777 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2778
2779 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2780
2781 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2782 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2783 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2784
2785 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2786 converted.
2787
2788 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2789 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2790 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2791 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2792 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2793 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2794 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002795 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2796 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002797
2798 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2799
2800 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2801 only need this line:
2802
2803 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2804
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002805tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2806 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002807 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002808 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2809 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2810 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2811 being used for too long.
2812
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002813tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2814 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2815 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2816 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2817 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2818 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2819 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2820 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2821 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2822 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2823 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002824 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002825 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002826
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002827tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2828 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2829 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2830 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2831 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002832 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002833 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2834 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002835 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2836 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002837
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002838tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2839 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2840 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2841 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2842 1000 entries.
2843
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002844tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2845 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2846 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2847 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2848
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002849tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002850tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002851tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2852tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2853tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002854 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2855 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2856 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2857 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2858 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2859 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2860 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2861 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002862
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002863 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2864 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2865 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2866 all available space is consumed.
2867 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2868 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2869 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002870
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002871tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2872 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002873 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002874 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002875 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002876 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2877
2878tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2879 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2880 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002881 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2882 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028843.3. Debugging
2885--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002886
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002887quiet
2888 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2889 line argument "-q".
2890
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002891zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002892 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002893 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2894 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2895 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2896 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2897 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2898
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029003.4. Userlists
2901--------------
2902It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2903http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2904it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2905
2906userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002907 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002908 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2909
2910group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002911 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002912 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2913 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2914
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002915user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2916 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2918 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002919 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2920 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2921 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2922 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002923
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002924 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2925 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2926 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2927 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2928 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2929 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2930 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002931 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002932 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002933
2934 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002935 userlist L1
2936 group G1 users tiger,scott
2937 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002938
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002939 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2940 user scott insecure-password elgato
2941 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002942
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002943 userlist L2
2944 group G1
2945 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002946
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002947 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2948 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2949 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002950
2951 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002952
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002953
29543.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002955----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002956It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002957several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002958instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2959values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2960automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2961In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2962using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2963tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2964reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2965Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2966that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2967each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002968
2969peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002970 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002971 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2972
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002973bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2974 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2975 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2976
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002977disabled
2978 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2979 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2980 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2981
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002982default-bind [param*]
2983 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2984
2985default-server [param*]
2986 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2987
2988 Arguments:
2989 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2990 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2991 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2992 details.
2993
2994
2995 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2996
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02002997enabled
2998 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
2999 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003000
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003001log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003002 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3003 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3004 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3005 more details.
3006
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003007peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003008 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3009 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003010 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003011 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003012 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3013 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3014 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003015
3016 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3017 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3018
3019 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003020 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3021 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3022 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003023
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003024 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3025 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003026
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003027 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3028 "server" keyword explanation below).
3029
3030server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003031 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003032 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3033 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3034 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3035 of this "peers" section).
3036 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3037
3038
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003039 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003040 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003041 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003042 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3043 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3044 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003045
3046 backend mybackend
3047 mode tcp
3048 balance roundrobin
3049 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3050 stick on src
3051
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003052 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3053 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003054
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003055 Example:
3056 peers mypeers
3057 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3058 default-server ssl verify none
3059 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3060 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003061
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003062
3063table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3064 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3065
3066 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3067 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003068 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003069 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3070 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3071 "stick-table" keyword).
3072
3073 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3074 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3075 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3076 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3077 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3078 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3079 of the stick-table name as follows:
3080
3081 peers mypeers
3082 peer A ...
3083 peer B ...
3084 table t1 ...
3085
3086 frontend fe1
3087 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3088
3089 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3090 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3091
3092 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3093 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3094 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3095 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3096 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3097 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3098 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3099
3100 peers mypeers
3101 peer A ...
3102 peer B ...
3103 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3104
3105 backend t1
3106 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3107
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003108 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003109 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3110 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3111
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031123.6. Mailers
3113------------
3114It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3115If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3116in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3117
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003118mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003119 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3120 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3121
3122mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3123 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3124
3125 Example:
3126 mailers mymailers
3127 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3128 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3129
3130 backend mybackend
3131 mode tcp
3132 balance roundrobin
3133
3134 email-alert mailers mymailers
3135 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3136 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3137
3138 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3139 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3140
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003141timeout mail <time>
3142 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3143 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3144 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3145 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3146
3147 Example:
3148 mailers mymailers
3149 timeout mail 20s
3150 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003151
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031523.7. Programs
3153-------------
3154In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3155master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3156managed the same way as the workers.
3157
3158During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3159sequence as a worker:
3160
3161 - the master is re-executed
3162 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3163 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3164 instance of the program
3165
3166During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3167
3168program <name>
3169 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3170 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3171 the management guide).
3172
3173command <command> [arguments*]
3174 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3175 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3176 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3177 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3178
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003179user <user name>
3180 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3181 See also "group".
3182
3183group <group name>
3184 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3185 See also "user".
3186
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003187option start-on-reload
3188no option start-on-reload
3189 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3190 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3191 program section.
3192
3193
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031943.8. HTTP-errors
3195----------------
3196
3197It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3198imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3199several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3200
3201http-errors <name>
3202 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3203 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3204
3205errorfile <code> <file>
3206 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3207
3208 Arguments :
3209 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003210 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003211 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003212
3213 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3214 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3215 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3216 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3217 before any chroot is performed.
3218
3219 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3220
3221 Example:
3222 http-errors website-1
3223 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3224 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3225 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3226
3227 http-errors website-2
3228 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3229 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3230 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3231
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032323.9. Rings
3233----------
3234
3235It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3236servers or traces.
3237
3238ring <ringname>
3239 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3240
3241description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003242 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003243 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3244
3245format <format>
3246 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3247
3248 Arguments:
3249 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3250 one of the following :
3251
3252 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3253 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3254 designed to be used with a local log server.
3255
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003256 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3257 field is stripped. This is the default.
3258 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3259 rfc3164.
3260
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003261 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3262 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3263 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3264 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3265 is the default.
3266
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003267 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003268 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3269
3270 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3271 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3272
3273 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3274 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3275 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3276 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3277 logger consumes.
3278
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003279 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3280 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3281 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3282 with a local log server.
3283
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003284 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3285 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3286 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3287 used with a local log server.
3288
3289maxlen <length>
3290 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3291 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3292 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3293
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003294server <name> <address> [param*]
3295 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3296 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3297 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3298 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3299 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3300 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3301 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3302 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3303 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003304 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3305 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003306
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003307size <size>
3308 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3309 set to BUFSIZE.
3310
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003311timeout connect <timeout>
3312 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3313
3314 Arguments :
3315 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3316 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3317 as explained at the top of this document.
3318
3319timeout server <timeout>
3320 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3321
3322 Arguments :
3323 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3325 as explained at the top of this document.
3326
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003327 Example:
3328 global
3329 log ring@myring local7
3330
3331 ring myring
3332 description "My local buffer"
3333 format rfc3164
3334 maxlen 1200
3335 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003336 timeout connect 5s
3337 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003338 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003339
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033403.10. Log forwarding
3341-------------------
3342
3343It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003344HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003345
3346log-forward <name>
3347 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3348
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003349backlog <conns>
3350 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3351 on connections accept.
3352
3353bind <addr> [param*]
3354 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003355 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3356 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3357 syslog protocol over TCP.
3358 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003359 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3360
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003361dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003362 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3363 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3364 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3365 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003366 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003367
3368log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003369log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003370 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3371 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3372 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003373 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003374 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3375 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3376 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003377 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003378
3379 Example:
3380 global
3381 log stderr format iso local7
3382
3383 ring myring
3384 description "My local buffer"
3385 format rfc5424
3386 maxlen 1200
3387 size 32764
3388 timeout connect 5s
3389 timeout server 10s
3390 # syslog tcp server
3391 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3392
3393 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003394 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3395 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003396 # all messages on stderr
3397 log global
3398 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3399 log ring@myring local0
3400 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3401 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3402 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3403 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3404 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003405
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003406maxconn <conns>
3407 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3408 10 is the default.
3409
3410timeout client <timeout>
3411 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034134. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003414----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003415
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003416Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003417 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3418 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3419 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3420 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003421
3422A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3423connections.
3424
3425A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3426to forward incoming connections.
3427
3428A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3429parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3430
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003431A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3432ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3433sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3434the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3435explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3436from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3437"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3438for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3439to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3440optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3441are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3442any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3443names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3444that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3445duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3446names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3447
3448Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3449settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3450of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3451profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3452timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3453
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003454All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3455'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3456case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3457
3458Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3459logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3460proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3461However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3462name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3463
3464Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3465and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003466bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003467protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3468modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3469arbitrary criteria.
3470
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003471In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3472a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003473the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003474
3475 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3476 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3477 between responses and new requests.
3478
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003479 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3480 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3481 client-facing connection remains open.
3482
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003483 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3484 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003485
3486The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3487frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3488following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003489weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003490
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003491 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003492
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003493 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3494 ----+-----+-----+----
3495 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3496 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003497 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3498 ----+-----+-----+----
3499 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003500
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003501It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003502only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3503within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003504as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003505content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003506and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3507possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003508
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003509There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003510first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003511processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003512second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003513protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3514is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3515new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003516to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003517process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3518already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3519HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3520evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3521one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3522
3523There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3524performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3525tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3526preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3527analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3528HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3529header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3530mitigate this drawback.
3531
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003532There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003533method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3534set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3535in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3536is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3537to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3538above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3539to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3540"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3541frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3542frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3543as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3544upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3545on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3546the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3547upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3548frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3549remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035514.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3552--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003554The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3555limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3556they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3557limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003558marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003559option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003560and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3561with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3562specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003564
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003565 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3566------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3567acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003568backlog X X X -
3569balance X - X X
3570bind - X X -
3571bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003572capture cookie - X X -
3573capture request header - X X -
3574capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003575clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3576clitcpka-idle X X X -
3577clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003578compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003579cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003580declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003581default-server X - X X
3582default_backend X X X -
3583description - X X X
3584disabled X X X X
3585dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003586email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003587email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003588email-alert mailers X X X X
3589email-alert myhostname X X X X
3590email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003591enabled X X X X
3592errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003593errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003594errorloc X X X X
3595errorloc302 X X X X
3596-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3597errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003598force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003599filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003600fullconn X - X X
3601grace X X X X
3602hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003603http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003604http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003605http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003606http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003607http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003608http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003609http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003610http-check set-var X - X X
3611http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003612http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003613http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003614http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003615http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003616http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003617id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003618ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003619load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003620log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003621log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003622log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003623log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003624max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003625maxconn X X X -
3626mode X X X X
3627monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003628monitor-uri X X X -
3629option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3630option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3631option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3632option allbackups (*) X - X X
3633option checkcache (*) X - X X
3634option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3635option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003636option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003637option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3638option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003639-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3640option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003641option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3642option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003643option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003644option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003645option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003646option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003647option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003648option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003649option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3650option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3651option httpchk X - X X
3652option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003653option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003655option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003656option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003657option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003658option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3659option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3660option logasap (*) X X X -
3661option mysql-check X - X X
3662option nolinger (*) X X X X
3663option originalto X X X X
3664option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003665option pgsql-check X - X X
3666option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003667option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003668option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003669option smtpchk X - X X
3670option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3671option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3672option splice-request (*) X X X X
3673option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003674option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003675option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3676option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3677-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003678option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003679option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3680option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3681option tcpka X X X X
3682option tcplog X X X X
3683option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003684option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003685external-check command X - X X
3686external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003687persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3688rate-limit sessions X X X -
3689redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003690-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003691retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003692retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003693server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003694server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003695server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003697srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3698srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3699srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003700stats admin - X X X
3701stats auth X X X X
3702stats enable X X X X
3703stats hide-version X X X X
3704stats http-request - X X X
3705stats realm X X X X
3706stats refresh X X X X
3707stats scope X X X X
3708stats show-desc X X X X
3709stats show-legends X X X X
3710stats show-node X X X X
3711stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003712-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3713stick match - - X X
3714stick on - - X X
3715stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003716stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003717stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003718tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003719tcp-check connect X - X X
3720tcp-check expect X - X X
3721tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003722tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003723tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003724tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003725tcp-check set-var X - X X
3726tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003727tcp-request connection - X X -
3728tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003729tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003730tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003731tcp-response content - - X X
3732tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003733timeout check X - X X
3734timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003735timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003736timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003737timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3738timeout http-request X X X X
3739timeout queue X - X X
3740timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003741timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003742timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003743timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003744transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003745unique-id-format X X X -
3746unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003747use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003748use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003749use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003750------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3751 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3755---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003756
3757This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3758
3759
3760acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3761 Declare or complete an access list.
3762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3763 no | yes | yes | yes
3764 Example:
3765 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3766 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3767 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003769 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003770
3771
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003772backlog <conns>
3773 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3775 yes | yes | yes | no
3776 Arguments :
3777 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3778 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003779 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003780
3781 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3782 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3783 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3784 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3785 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3786 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3787 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3788 backlog parameter.
3789
3790 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3791 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3792 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3793
3794 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3795
3796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003797balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003798balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003799 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | no | yes | yes
3802 Arguments :
3803 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3804 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3805 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3806 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3807
3808 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3809 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3810 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3811 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003812 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003813 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003814 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3815 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3816 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3817 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3818 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3819 it, so that you don't worry.
3820
3821 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3822 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3823 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3824 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3825 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3826 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3827 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3828 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003829
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003830 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3831 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3832 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3833 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3834 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3835 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3836 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003837 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3838 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3839 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003840
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003841 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003842 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003843 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3844 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003845 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003846 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3847 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3848 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3849 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3850 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003851 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3852 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3853 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3854 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3855 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3856 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003858 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3859 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3860 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3861 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3862 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3863 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3864 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3865 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003866 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003867 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003868 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3869 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3870 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003871
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003872 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3873 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3874 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3875 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3876 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3877 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3878 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3879 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3880 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3881 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3882 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3883 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003884
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003885 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003886 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3887 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3888 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3889 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3890 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3891 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3892 URIs start with a leading "/".
3893
3894 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3895 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3896 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3897 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3898
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003899 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3900 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3901 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3902 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3903
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003904 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003905 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3906
3907 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003908 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3909 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003910 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3911 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3912 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3913 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003914 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003915 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3916 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003917
3918 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3919 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3920 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3921 server will receive the request.
3922
3923 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3924 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3925 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3926 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3927 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003928 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3929 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3930 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003931
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003932 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3933 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3934 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3935 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3936 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003937
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003938 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003939 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3940 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3941 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3942
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003943 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3944 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3945 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3946
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003947 random
3948 random(<draws>)
3949 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003950 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3951 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3952 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3953 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003954 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3955 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3956 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3957 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3958 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3959 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3960 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3961 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3962 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3963 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3964 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3965 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3966 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3967 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3968 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3969 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3970 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3971 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3972 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3973 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003974
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003975 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003976 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003977 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3978 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003979 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003980 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3981 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3982 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003983 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003984 used instead.
3985
3986 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3987 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3988 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003989 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003990
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003991 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3992 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3993 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3994
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003995 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003996 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3997 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003998
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003999 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4000 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4001 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004002
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004003 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004004 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004005 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4006 NTLM relies on.
4007
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004008 Examples :
4009 balance roundrobin
4010 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004011 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004012 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4013 balance hdr(host)
4014 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004015
4016 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4017 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004019 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004020 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4021 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4022 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004023 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004024
4025 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4026 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4027 defaults to 16 kB.
4028
4029 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4030 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4031
4032 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4033 Round Robin.
4034
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004035 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004036 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4037 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4038 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4039
4040 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4041
4042 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004043 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004044 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4045 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4046 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004047
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004048 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004049
4050
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004051bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4052bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004053 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4055 no | yes | yes | no
4056 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004057 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4058 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4059 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4060 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004061 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004062 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4063 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4064 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4065 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4066 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4067 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004068 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004069 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4070 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004071 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004072 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4073 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004074 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004075 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4076 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004077 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004078 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4079 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4080 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4081 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4082 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4083 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4084 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004085 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4086 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4087 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004088 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4089 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4090 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4091 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004092 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4093 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4094 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004095
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004096 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4097 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004098 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4099 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4100 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004101 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4102 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4103 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4104 the range.
4105
4106 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4107 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4108 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4109 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4110 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4111 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4112 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004113 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004114 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004115
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004116 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004117 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004118 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4119 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4120 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4121 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4122 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4123 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4124
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004125 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4126 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4127 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4128 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4131 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4132 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4133 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4134 in a frontend.
4135
4136 Example :
4137 listen http_proxy
4138 bind :80,:443
4139 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004140 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004141
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004142 listen http_https_proxy
4143 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004144 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004145
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004146 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4147 bind ipv6@:80
4148 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4149 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4150
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004151 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004152 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004153
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004154 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4155 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4156 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4157 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4158 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4159
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004160 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004161 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004162
4163
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004164bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004165 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4167 yes | yes | yes | yes
4168 Arguments :
4169 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4170 may be used to override a default value.
4171
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004172 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004173 option may be combined with other numbers.
4174
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004175 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004176 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4177 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4178 missing from all processes.
4179
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004180 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004181 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004182 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4183 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4184 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4185 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4186 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004187 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004188
4189 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4190 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4191 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4192 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4193 and 'even' instances.
4194
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004195 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4196 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4197 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4198 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004199
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004200 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4201 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4202
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004203 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4204 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4205 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4206
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004207 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4208 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4209
4210 Example :
4211 listen app_ip1
4212 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004213 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004214
4215 listen app_ip2
4216 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004217 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004218
4219 listen management
4220 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004221 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004222
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004223 listen management
4224 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4225 bind-process 1-4
4226
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004227 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004228
4229
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004230capture cookie <name> len <length>
4231 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4233 no | yes | yes | no
4234 Arguments :
4235 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4236 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4237 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4238 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004239 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004240
4241 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4242 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4243 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4244 right if it exceeds <length>.
4245
4246 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4247 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4248 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4249 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4250
4251 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4252 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4253 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4254
4255 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4256 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4257 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004258 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4259 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4260 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004261
4262 Example:
4263 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4264
4265 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004266 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004267
4268
4269capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004270 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4272 no | yes | yes | no
4273 Arguments :
4274 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004275 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004276 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4277 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4278 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4279
4280 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4281 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4282 it exceeds <length>.
4283
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004284 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004285 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4286 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004287 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4288 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4289 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4290 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004291 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004292 environments to find where the request came from.
4293
4294 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4295 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4296 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4297 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004298
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004299 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4300 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4301 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4302 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4303 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004304
4305 Example:
4306 capture request header Host len 15
4307 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004308 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004310 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004311 about logging.
4312
4313
4314capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004315 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4317 no | yes | yes | no
4318 Arguments :
4319 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004320 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004321 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4322 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4323 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4324
4325 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4326 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4327 it exceeds <length>.
4328
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004329 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004330 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4331 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4332 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004333 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4334 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4335 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4336 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004337
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004338 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4339 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4340 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4341 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4342 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004343
4344 Example:
4345 capture response header Content-length len 9
4346 capture response header Location len 15
4347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004348 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349 about logging.
4350
4351
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004352clitcpka-cnt <count>
4353 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4354 the connection on the client side.
4355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4356 yes | yes | yes | no
4357 Arguments :
4358 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4359
4360 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4361 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004362 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4363 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004364
4365 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4366
4367
4368clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4369 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4370 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4371 client side.
4372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4373 yes | yes | yes | no
4374 Arguments :
4375 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4376 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4377 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4378 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4379
4380 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4381 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004382 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4383 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004384
4385 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4386
4387
4388clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4389 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4391 yes | yes | yes | no
4392 Arguments :
4393 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4394 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4395 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4396 document.
4397
4398 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4399 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004400 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4401 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004402
4403 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4404
4405
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004406compression algo <algorithm> ...
4407compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004408compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004409 Enable HTTP compression.
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 yes | yes | yes | yes
4412 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004413 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4414 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004415 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004416
4417 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004418 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4419 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4420 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004421
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004422 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004423 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004424
4425 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4426 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4427 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4428 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4429 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004430 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004431
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004432 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4433 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4434 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4435 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4436 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4437 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4438 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004439 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004440
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004441 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004442 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004443 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004444 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004445 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004446 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004447 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004448
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004449 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004450 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4451 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004452 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4453 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004454 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004455 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004456 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4457 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004458 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004459 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4460 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004461
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004462 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004463 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4464 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004465 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004466 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004467 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4468 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4469 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4470 "multipart"
4471 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4472 header
4473 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4474 and later
4475 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4476 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004477 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004478
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004479 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004480
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004481 Examples :
4482 compression algo gzip
4483 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004484
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004485
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004486cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004487 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4488 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004489 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4492 yes | no | yes | yes
4493 Arguments :
4494 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4495 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4496 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4497 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4498 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4499 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004500 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004501 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4502 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4503
4504 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004505 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004506 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4507 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4508 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4509 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004510 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4511 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004512 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004513 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4514 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004515
4516 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004517 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004518
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004519 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004520 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004521 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004522 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004523 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4524 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4525 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4526 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4527 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4528 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4529 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004530
4531 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4532 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4533 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4534 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4535 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4536 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4537 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4538 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4539 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004540 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004541 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4542 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4543 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004544
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004545 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4546 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4547 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004548 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4549 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4550 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4551 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004552 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4553 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4554 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004555
4556 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4557 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4558 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4559 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4560 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4561 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4562 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4563 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4564 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4565
4566 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4567 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4568 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4569 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4570 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4571 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4572 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4573 persistence cookie in the cache.
4574 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4575
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004576 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4577 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004578 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004579 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4580 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004581 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004582 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4583 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4584 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4585 they logout.
4586
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004587 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004588 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4589 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4590 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4591
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004592 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004593 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4594 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4595 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4596 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4597 this attribute.
4598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004599 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004600 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004601 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4602 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4603 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4604 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4605 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4606 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004607
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004608 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4609 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4610 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4611 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4612 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4613 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4614 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4615 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004616 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004617 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4618 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4619 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4620 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4621 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4622 the site.
4623
4624 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4625 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4626 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4627 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4628 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4629 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4630 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4631 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4632 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4633 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4634 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4635 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4636 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004637 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004638 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4639 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4640
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004641 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4642 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4643 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4644 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4645 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4646 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4647
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004648 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004649 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4650 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4651 repeated.
4652
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004653 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4654 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4655 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4656 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004657
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004658 Examples :
4659 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4660 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4661 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004662 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004663
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004664 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004665
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004666
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004667declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4668 Declares a capture slot.
4669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4670 no | yes | yes | no
4671 Arguments:
4672 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4673
4674 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4675 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4676 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4677 for use in the response.
4678
4679 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004680 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004681 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4682
4683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004684default-server [param*]
4685 Change default options for a server in a backend
4686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4687 yes | no | yes | yes
4688 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004689 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4690 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4691 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4692 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004693
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004694 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004695 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4696
4697 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004698
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004700default_backend <backend>
4701 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4703 yes | yes | yes | no
4704 Arguments :
4705 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4706
4707 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4708 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4709 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4710 will catch all undetermined requests.
4711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004712 Example :
4713
4714 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4715 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4716 default_backend dynamic
4717
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004718 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004720
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004721description <string>
4722 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4724 no | yes | yes | yes
4725 Arguments : string
4726
4727 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4728 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4729 it describes.
4730 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4731
4732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004733disabled
4734 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4736 yes | yes | yes | yes
4737 Arguments : none
4738
4739 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4740 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4741 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4742 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4743 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4744 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4745 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4746
4747 See also : "enabled"
4748
4749
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004750dispatch <address>:<port>
4751 Set a default server address
4752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4753 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004754 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004755
4756 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4757 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4758 during start-up.
4759
4760 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4761 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4762 possible with normal servers.
4763
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004764 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004765 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4766 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4767 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4768 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4769
4770 See also : "server"
4771
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004772
4773dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4774 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4776 yes | no | yes | yes
4777 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4778
4779 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004780 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004781 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4782 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004783 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004784 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004786enabled
4787 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4789 yes | yes | yes | yes
4790 Arguments : none
4791
4792 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4793 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4794
4795 See also : "disabled"
4796
4797
4798errorfile <code> <file>
4799 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4801 yes | yes | yes | yes
4802 Arguments :
4803 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004804 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004805 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004806
4807 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004808 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004809 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004810 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4811 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004812
4813 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4814 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4815 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4816
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004817 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4818
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004819 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4820 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4821 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4822 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4823 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4824 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4825 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4826 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4827 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004828
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004829 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4830 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4831 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004832 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004833 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4834
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004835 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004836
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004837 Example :
4838 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004839 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004840 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4841 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4842
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004843
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004844errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4845 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4846 section.
4847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4848 yes | yes | yes | yes
4849 Arguments :
4850 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4851
4852 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004853 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004854 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4855 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004856
4857 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4858 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4859 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4860 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4861 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004862 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004863 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4864
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004865 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4866 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004867
4868 Example :
4869 errorfiles generic
4870 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4871
4872
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004873errorloc <code> <url>
4874errorloc302 <code> <url>
4875 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4877 yes | yes | yes | yes
4878 Arguments :
4879 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004880 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004881 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004882
4883 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4884 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4885 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4886 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004887 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004888
4889 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4890 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4891 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4892
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004893 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4894
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004895 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4896 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4897 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4898 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004899 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004900 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4901 request.
4902
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004903 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004904
4905
4906errorloc303 <code> <url>
4907 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4909 yes | yes | yes | yes
4910 Arguments :
4911 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004912 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004913 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004914
4915 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4916 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4917 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4918 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004919 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004920
4921 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4922 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4923 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4924
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004925 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4926
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004927 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4928 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4929 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4930 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004931 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004932
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004933 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004934
4935
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004936email-alert from <emailaddr>
4937 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004938 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4940 yes | yes | yes | yes
4941
4942 Arguments :
4943
4944 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4945
4946 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4947 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4948
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004949 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004950 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4951 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004952
4953
4954email-alert level <level>
4955 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4956 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4957 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4958 yes | yes | yes | yes
4959
4960 Arguments :
4961
4962 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4963 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4964 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4965
4966 By default level is alert
4967
4968 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4969 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4970 for the proxy.
4971
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004972 Alerts are sent when :
4973
4974 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4975 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4976 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4977 is notice or lower
4978 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4979 and a health check status update occurs
4980
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004981 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4982 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004983 section 3.6 about mailers.
4984
4985
4986email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4987 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4989 yes | yes | yes | yes
4990
4991 Arguments :
4992
4993 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4994
4995 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4996 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4997
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004998 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4999 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005000
5001
5002email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5003 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5004 mailers.
5005 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5006 yes | yes | yes | yes
5007
5008 Arguments :
5009
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005010 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005011
5012 By default the systems hostname is used.
5013
5014 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5015 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5016 for the proxy.
5017
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005018 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5019 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005020
5021
5022email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005023 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005024 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5026 yes | yes | yes | yes
5027
5028 Arguments :
5029
5030 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5031
5032 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5033 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5034
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005035 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005036 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5037
5038
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005039force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5040 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005042 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005043
5044 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5045 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5046 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5047 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5048 marked down for maintenance operations.
5049
5050 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5051 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5052 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5053 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5054 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5055 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5056 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5057 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5058 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5059
5060 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5061 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5062 is used.
5063
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005064 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005065 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005066
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005067
5068filter <name> [param*]
5069 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5071 no | yes | yes | yes
5072 Arguments :
5073 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5074 referenced in section 9.
5075
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005076 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005077 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005078 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5079 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005080
5081 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5082 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5083
5084 Example:
5085 listen
5086 bind *:80
5087
5088 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5089 filter compression
5090 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5091
5092 compression algo gzip
5093 compression offload
5094
5095 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5096
5097 See also : section 9.
5098
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005099
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005100fullconn <conns>
5101 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5103 yes | no | yes | yes
5104 Arguments :
5105 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5106 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5107
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005108 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005109 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005110 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005111 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5112 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5113 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5114 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5115 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005116 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005117
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005118 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005119 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005120 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5121 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5122 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005123
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005124 Example :
5125 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5126 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5127 # connections.
5128 backend dynamic
5129 fullconn 10000
5130 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5131 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5132
5133 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5134
5135
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005136grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005137 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005139 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005140 Arguments :
5141 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5142 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5143 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5144
5145 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5146 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005147 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005148 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5149
5150 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5151 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5152 simplify it.
5153
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005154
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005155hash-balance-factor <factor>
5156 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5158 yes | no | no | yes
5159 Arguments :
5160 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5161 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005162 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005163
5164 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5165 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5166 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5167 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5168 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5169 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5170 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5171
5172 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5173 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5174 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5175 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5176 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5177
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005178 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5179 consistent hashing mechanism.
5180
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005181 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5182
5183
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005184hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005185 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 yes | no | yes | yes
5188 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005189 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5190 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005191
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005192 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5193 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5194 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5195 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5196 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5197 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5198 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5199 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5200 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5201 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005202
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005203 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5204 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5205 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5206 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5207 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5208 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5209 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5210 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5211 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5212 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5213 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5214 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5215 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005216 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5217 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005218
5219 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5220
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005221 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005222 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5223 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5224 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005225 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5226 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5227 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005228
5229 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5230 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005231 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5232 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5233 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5234 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5235
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005236 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005237 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5238 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5239 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5240 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5241 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5242 parameter.
5243
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005244 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5245 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5246 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5247 used on strings.
5248
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005249 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5250
5251 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5252 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5253 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5254 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5255 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5256 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5257 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5258 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5259 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5260 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5261 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5262 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005263
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005264 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5265 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5266 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005267
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005268 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005269
5270
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005271http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5272 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5273 ones).
5274
5275 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5276 no | yes | yes | yes
5277
5278 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5279 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5280 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5281 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5282 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5283 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5284
5285 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5286 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5287 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5288
5289 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5290 below.
5291
5292 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5293 instance.
5294
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005295 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5296 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5297 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5298
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005299 Example:
5300 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5301 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5302 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5303
5304http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5305
5306 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5307 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5308 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5309 example, or to pass some internal information.
5310 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5311 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5312 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5313
5314http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5315
5316 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5317 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5318
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005319http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005320
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005321 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5322 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5323 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5324 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5325 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005326
5327http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5328 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5329
5330 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5331
5332 Example:
5333 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5334
5335 # applied to:
5336 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5337
5338 # outputs:
5339 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5340
5341 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5342
5343http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5344 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5345
5346 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5347
5348 Example:
5349 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5350
5351 # applied to:
5352 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5353
5354 # outputs:
5355 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5356
5357http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5358
5359 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5360 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5361 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5362
5363http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5365
5366 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5367 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5368 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5369 fallback.
5370
5371 Example:
5372 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5373 http-response set-status 431
5374 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5375 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5376
5377http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5378
5379 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5380 inline.
5381
5382 Arguments:
5383 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5384 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5385 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5386 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5387 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5388 (request and response)
5389 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5390 processing
5391 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5392 processing
5393 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5394 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5395 and '_'.
5396
5397 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5398 followed by some converters.
5399
5400 Example:
5401 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5402
5403http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5404
5405 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5406 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5407 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5408 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5409 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005410 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005411 processing.
5412
5413 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5414 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005415 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005416 rules evaluation.
5417
5418http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5419
5420 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5421 details about <var-name>.
5422
5423 Example:
5424 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5425
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005426
5427http-check comment <string>
5428 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5429 it fails.
5430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 yes | no | yes | yes
5432
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005433 Arguments :
5434 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5435 rule fails.
5436
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005437 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5438 user-friendly error reporting.
5439
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005440 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005441 "http-check expect".
5442
5443
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005444http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5445 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005446 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005447 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5449 yes | no | yes | yes
5450
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005451 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005452 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5453
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005454 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005455 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005456
5457 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5458 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5459 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5460 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5461
5462 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5463
5464 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5465
5466 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5467
5468 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5469
5470 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5471
5472 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5473 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5474 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5475 is used.
5476
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005477 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5478 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5479 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5480 haproxy -vv.
5481
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005482 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5483
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005484 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5485 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5486 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5487 different ports or with different servers.
5488
5489 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5490 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5491 the port with a "http-check connect".
5492
5493 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5494 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5495 do.
5496
5497 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5498 unset-var or comment rules.
5499
5500 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005501 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5502 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5503 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5504 option httpchk
5505
5506 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005507 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005508 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005509 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005510 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005511 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005512
5513 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5514
5515 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005516
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005518http-check disable-on-404
5519 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005521 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005522 Arguments : none
5523
5524 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5525 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5526 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5527 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5528 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5529 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5530 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5531 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005532 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5533 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005534 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5535 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5536 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005537
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005538 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005539
5540
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005541http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005542 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5543 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5544 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005545 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005547 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005548
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005549 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005550 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5551
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005552 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5553 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5554 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5555 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5556 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5557 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5558 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5559 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5560 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5561 result is always conclusive.
5562
5563 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5564 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5565 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005566 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5567 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005568 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5569 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005570 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5571 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5572 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005573
5574 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5575 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005576 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5577 supported :
5578 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5579 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005580 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5581 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5582 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5583 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5584 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005585
5586 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5587 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005588 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5589 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5590 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5591 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005592 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5593
5594 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5595 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5596 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5597 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5598
5599 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5600 informational message reported in logs if an error
5601 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5602 log-format string.
5603
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005604 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005605 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5606 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005607 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5608 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5609 details on the supported keywords.
5610
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005611 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5612 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5613 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5614 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005615
5616 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5617 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5618 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5619 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5620 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5621
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005622 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5623 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5624 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5625 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5626 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5627 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5628 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005629
5630 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005631 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005632 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5633 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5634 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5635 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5636
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005637 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5638 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005639 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5640 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5641 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5642 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5643 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5644 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5645 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5646 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005647 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5648 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5649 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5650 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5651 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5652 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5653 insensitive on the header names.
5654
5655 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5656 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5657 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5658 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5659 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5660 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005661
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005662 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005663 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005664 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5665 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5666 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5667 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5668 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005669 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005670 trace).
5671
5672 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005673 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005674 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5675 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5676 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5677 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5678 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005679 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005680
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005681 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5682 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5683 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5684 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5685 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5686 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5687
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005688 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005689 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005690 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5691 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5692 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5693 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5694 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5695 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5696
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005697 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5698 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5699 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5700 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5701 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005702
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005703 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5704 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5705
5706 Examples :
5707 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005708 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005709
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005710 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5711 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5712
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005713 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005714 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005715
5716 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005717 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005718
5719 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005720 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005721
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005722 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005723 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005724
5725
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005726http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005727 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5728 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005729 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5730 health checks.
5731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5732 yes | no | yes | yes
5733 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005734 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5735
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005736 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5737 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5738 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5739 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5740 to invent non-standard ones.
5741
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005742 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5743 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5744 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5745 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5746
5747 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5748 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5749 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5750 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005751
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005752 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005753 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005754 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005755 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5756 to add it.
5757
5758 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5759 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5760 to the log-format rules.
5761
5762 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5763 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5764 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005765
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005766 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5767 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5768 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5769 request.
5770
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005771 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5772 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5773 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005774 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5775 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5776 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5777 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005778 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005779
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005780 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005781 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5782 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005783
5784 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5785 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5786 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5787 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5788 configured request authority.
5789
5790 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5791 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005792
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005793 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005794
5795
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005796http-check send-state
5797 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5799 yes | no | yes | yes
5800 Arguments : none
5801
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005802 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005803 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005804 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5805 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5806 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005807
5808 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5809 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5810 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5811 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5812 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005813 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5814 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5815 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5816
5817 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5818 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5819 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5820
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005821 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5822 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5823 checked in multiple backends.
5824
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005825 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005826 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5827
5828 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5829 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5830 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5831 one fails.
5832
5833 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5834 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5835 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5836
5837 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5838 server's queue.
5839
5840 Example of a header received by the application server :
5841 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5842 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5843
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005844 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5845 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005846
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005847
5848http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005849 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005850 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5851 yes | no | yes | yes
5852
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005853 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005854 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5855 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5856 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5857 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5858 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5859 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5860 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5861 and '-'.
5862
5863 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5864
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005865 Examples :
5866 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005867
5868
5869http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005870 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005871 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5872 yes | no | yes | yes
5873
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005874 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005875 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5876 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5877 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5878 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5879 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5880 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5881 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5882 and '-'.
5883
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005884 Examples :
5885 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005887
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005888http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5889 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5890 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5891 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5892 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5894 yes | yes | yes | yes
5895 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005896 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005897 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005898 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005899 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005900
5901 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5902 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5903 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5904 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5905
5906 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5907 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5908 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5909 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5910
5911 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5912 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5913 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5914 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5915 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5916 chroot is performed.
5917
5918 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5919 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5920 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5921 considered.
5922
5923 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5924 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5925 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5926 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5927 considered as a raw string.
5928
5929 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5930 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5931 "content-type".
5932
5933 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5934 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5935 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5936 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5937 evaluated as a log-format string.
5938
5939 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5940 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5941 argument to "content-type".
5942
5943 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5944 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5945 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5946 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5947
5948 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5949 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5950 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5951 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5952 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5953 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5954 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5955 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5956
5957 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5958 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5959 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5960
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005961 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5962 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5963 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5964 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5965 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5966
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005967 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5968 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5969
5970
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005971http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005972 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5973
5974 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5975 no | yes | yes | yes
5976
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005977 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5978 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5979 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5980 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5981 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005983 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5984 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005985
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005986 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005987
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005988 Example:
5989 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5990 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5991 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005993 http-request allow if nagios
5994 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5995 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5996 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005998 Example:
5999 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6000 acl add path /addacl
6001 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006004
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006005 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6006 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008 Example:
6009 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6010 acl setmap path /setmap
6011 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006013 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006014
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006015 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6016 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006018 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6019 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006023 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6024 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6025 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6026 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6027 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6028 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6029 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6030 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006032http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6035 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6036 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6037 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6038 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6039 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6040 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6041 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006045 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6046 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006047
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006049http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6052 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6053 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6054 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6055 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006056
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006057 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6058 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6059 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6060 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6061 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6062 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6063 instead.
6064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006065 Example:
6066 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6067 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006068
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006069http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006070
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006071 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006072
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006073http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6074 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006076 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6077 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6078 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6079 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6080 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6081 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6082 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6083 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6084 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006086 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6087 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6088 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006089 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6090
6091 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6092 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6093 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6094 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006096http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006098 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6099 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6100 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6101 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6102 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6103 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006104
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006105http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006106
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006107 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6108 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6109 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6110 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6111 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006113http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006115 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6116 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6117 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6118 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6119 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6120 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006121
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006122http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6123http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6124 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6125 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6126 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6127 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006128
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006129 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6130 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6131 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006132 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006133 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6134 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6135 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006136 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006137 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006138
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006139http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6140 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6141 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6142 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6143
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006144http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6145
6146 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6147 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6148 pointed by <resolvers>.
6149 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6150 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6151 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6152 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6153 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6154 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6155 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6156 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6157 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6158 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6159 to 0.0.0.0.
6160
6161 Example:
6162 resolvers mydns
6163 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6164 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6165 timeout retry 1s
6166 hold valid 10s
6167 hold nx 3s
6168 hold other 3s
6169 hold obsolete 0s
6170 accepted_payload_size 8192
6171
6172 frontend fe
6173 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6174 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6175 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6176
6177 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6178 # which mean DNS resolution error
6179 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6180
6181 default_backend be
6182
6183 backend b_503
6184 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6185 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6186 # 503 error page to end users
6187
6188 backend be
6189 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6190 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6191 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6192 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6193 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6194
6195 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6196 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6197
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006198http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6199
6200 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6201 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6202 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6203 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006204 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6205 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006206
6207 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6208
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006209http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006210http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006211http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006212http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006213http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006214http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006215http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006216http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6217http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006218
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006219 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6220
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006221 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006222 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6223 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6224 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6225 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006226
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006227 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6228 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6229 the supported backend.
6230
6231 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6232 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6233 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6234 number of segments in the path.
6235
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006236 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6237 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6238 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6239 when improperly combined.
6240
6241 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6242 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6243 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6244 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6245 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6246
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006247 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006248
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006249 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6250
6251 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6252 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6253
6254 Example:
6255 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6256
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006257 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6258
6259 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6260 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6261
6262 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6263 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6264
6265 Example:
6266 - /#foo -> /
6267
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006268 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6269 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006270
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006271 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6272 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6273
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006274 Example:
6275 - /. -> /
6276 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6277 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6278 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006279
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006280 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6281 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6282
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006283 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006284 their preceding segment.
6285
6286 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6287 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6288
6289 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6290 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006291
6292 Example:
6293 - /foo/../ -> /
6294 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6295 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6296 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006297 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006298 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006299 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006300
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006301 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6302 removed as well:
6303
6304 Example:
6305 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6306 - /bar/../../ -> /
6307
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006308 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6309 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006310
6311 Example:
6312 - // -> /
6313 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6314
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006315 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6316 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6317
6318 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6319 ".", "_", and "~".
6320
6321 Example:
6322 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6323 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6324 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6325 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6326
6327 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6328 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6329
6330 Example:
6331 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6332 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6333
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006334 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006335 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006336
6337 Example:
6338 - /%6f -> /%6F
6339 - /%zz -> /%zz
6340
6341 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6342 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6343
6344 Example:
6345 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6346
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006347 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006348 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6349 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6350
6351 Example:
6352 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6353 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6354 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006356http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006358 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6359 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6360 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6361 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6362 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006364http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006366 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6367 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6368 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6369 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006371http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006373
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006374 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006375 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6376 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6377 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6378 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6379 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006380
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006381 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6382 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6383 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6384 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6385 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006386
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006387 Example:
6388 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6389
6390 # applied to:
6391 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6392
6393 # outputs:
6394 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6395
6396 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006397
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006398 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6399
6400 # applied to:
6401 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006402
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006403 # outputs:
6404 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006405
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006406http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6407 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6408
6409 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6410 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006411 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6412 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6413 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006414
6415 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6416 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6417 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6418
6419 Example:
6420 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6421 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6422
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006423 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6424 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6425 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6426 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6427
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006428http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6429 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6430
6431 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6432 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6433 query-string are replaced.
6434
6435 Example:
6436 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6437 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6438
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006439http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6440 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6441
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006442 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6443 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6444 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6445 against.
6446
6447 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6448 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6449 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006450
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006451 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6452 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6453 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6454 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6455 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6456 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6457 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6458 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6459 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006460 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6461 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006462
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006463 Example:
6464 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6465 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006466
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006467 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6468 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006470http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6471 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006472
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006473 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6474 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6475 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6476 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006477
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006478 Example:
6479 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006480
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006481 # applied to:
6482 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006483
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006484 # outputs:
6485 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006486
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006487http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6488 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6489 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006490 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006491 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6492
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006493 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006494 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6495 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006496 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006497 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006498 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006499 are followed to create the response :
6500
6501 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6502 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6503 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6504 ignored.
6505
6506 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6507 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006508 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006509 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6510 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006511
6512 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6513 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6514 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006515 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006516 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006517
6518 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6519 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6520 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006521 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006522 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006523 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006524
6525 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6526 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6527 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6528 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6529 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6530 as a raw content.
6531
6532 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6533 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6534 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6535 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6536 considered as a raw string.
6537
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006538 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006539 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6540 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6541 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6542
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006543 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6544 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006545 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006546
6547 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6548
6549 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006550 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006551 if { path /ping }
6552
6553 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6554 if { path /favicon.ico }
6555
6556 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6557 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6558 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006560http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6561http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006563 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6564 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6565 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006566
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006567http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6568 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006569
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006570 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6571 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6572 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6573 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006575http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006577 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6578 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6579 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6580 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6581 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006583 Arguments:
6584 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6585 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587 Example:
6588 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6589 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006591 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6592 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6597 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6598 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006600 Arguments:
6601 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6602 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006604 Example:
6605 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6606 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006608 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6609 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6610 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006612http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6615 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6616 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6617 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6618 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 Example:
6621 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6622 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6623 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6624 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6625 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6626 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6627 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6628 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6629 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006631http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006633 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6634 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6635 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6636 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6637 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6640 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006642 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6643 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6644 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6645 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6646 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6647 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6648 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6649 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6650 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006652http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6655 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6656 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6657 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6658 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6659 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6660 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006662http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006664 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6665 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6666 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006668http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006670 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6671 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6672 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6673 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6674 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6675 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6676 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6677 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006679http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006681 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6682 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6683 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6684 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6685 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6686 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006688 Example :
6689 # prepend the host name before the path
6690 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006691
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006692http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6693
6694 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6695 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6696 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006698http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6701 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6702 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6703 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6704 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006706http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006708 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6709 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6710 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6711 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6712 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6713 values have higher priority.
6714 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6715 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6716 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6717 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6718 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006722 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6723 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6724 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6725 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6726 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6727 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6728 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006730 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006731
6732 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006733 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6734 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006736http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6737 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6738 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6739 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006740 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6741 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006742
6743 Arguments :
6744 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6745 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006746
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006747 See also "option forwardfor".
6748
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006749 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006750 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6751 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6752
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006753 # After the masking this will track connections
6754 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6755 http-request track-sc0 src
6756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006757 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6758 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6759
6760http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6761
6762 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6763 expression.
6764
6765 Arguments:
6766 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6767 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006768
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006769 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006770 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6771 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6772
6773 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6774 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6775 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6776
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006777http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006778 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6779
6780 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6781 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6782 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6783 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6784 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6785
6786 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6787 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6788 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6789 results.
6790
6791 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006792 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6793 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006795http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6796
6797 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6798 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6799 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6800 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6801 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6802 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6803 information from the request.
6804
6805 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6806
6807http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6808
6809 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6810 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6811 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6812 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6813 path and the query string.
6814 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6815
6816http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6817
6818 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6819 inline.
6820
6821 Arguments:
6822 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6823 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6824 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6825 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6826 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6827 (request and response)
6828 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6829 processing
6830 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6831 processing
6832 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6833 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6834 and '_'.
6835
6836 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6837 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006838
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006839 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006840 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006841
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006842http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6843 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006845 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6846 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6847 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6848 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6849 agent name must be used.
6850
6851 Arguments:
6852 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6853
6854 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6855 configuration.
6856
6857http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6858
6859 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6860 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6861 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6862 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6863 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6864 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6865 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6866 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6867 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6868 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6869 action.
6870 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6871 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6872 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6873 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6874 you fully understand how it works.
6875
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006876http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6877
6878 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6879 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6880 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6881 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6882 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006883 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006884 processing.
6885
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006886 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006887 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6888 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6889 rules evaluation.
6890
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006891http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6892http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6893 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6894 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6895 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6896 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006897
6898 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6899 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6900 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006901 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6902 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6903 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6904 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6905 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6906 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006907 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006908 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6909 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6910 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006911 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006912 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6913 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6914 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6915 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6916 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006917
6918http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6919http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6920http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6921
6922 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6923 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6924 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6925 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006926 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006927 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6928 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6929 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6930 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6931 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6932 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6933 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6934
6935 Arguments :
6936 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6937 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6938 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6939 select which table entry to update the counters.
6940
6941 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6942 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6943 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6944 that table until the session ends.
6945
6946 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6947 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6948 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6949 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6950 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6951 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6952 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6953 useful information.
6954
6955 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6956 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6957 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6958 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6959 checks that make use of it.
6960
6961http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6962
6963 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006964
6965 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006966 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006967
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006968http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6969
6970 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6971 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6972 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6973 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6974 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6975 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6976
6977 Arguments :
6978 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6979
6980 Example:
6981 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6982
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006983http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6984 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6985
6986 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6987 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6988 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6989 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6990 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6991 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6992 http-buffer-request".
6993
6994 Arguments :
6995
6996 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6997 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6998
6999 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007000 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007001 bytes.
7002
7003 Example:
7004 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7005
7006 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007008http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007009
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007010 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7011 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7012 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007013
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007015http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007016 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7017
7018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7019 no | yes | yes | yes
7020
7021 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7022 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7023 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7024 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7025 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7026 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007028 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7029 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007031 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007033 Example:
7034 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007036 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007038 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7039 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007041 Example:
7042 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007044 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007046 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7047 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007049 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7050 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007054 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7055 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7056 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7057 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7058 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7059 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7060 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7061 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007062
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007063http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007065 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7066 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7067 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7068 example, or to pass some internal information.
7069 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7070 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7071 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007073http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007075 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7076 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007077
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007078http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007079
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007080 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007082http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007084 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7085 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7086 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7087 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7088 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7089 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7090 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007092 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7093 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7094 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7095 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7096 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007097
7098 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7099 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7100 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7101 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007103http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007105 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7106 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7107 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7108 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7109 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7110 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007111
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007112http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007113
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007114 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7115 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7116 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7117 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7118 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007120http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007122 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7123 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7124 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7125 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7126 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7127 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007128
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007129http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7130http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7131 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7132 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7133 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7134 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007135
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007136 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7137 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7138 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007139 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007140 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7141 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7142 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007143 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007144 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007146http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007147
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007148 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7149 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7150 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7151 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7152 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7153 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007155http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7156 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007157
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007158 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7159 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007161 Example:
7162 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007164 # applied to:
7165 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007167 # outputs:
7168 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007170 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007172http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7173 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007174
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007175 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007176 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007178 Example:
7179 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007181 # applied to:
7182 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007184 # outputs:
7185 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007186
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007187http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7188 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7189 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007190 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007191 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7192
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007193 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007194 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7195 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007196 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007197 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007198 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007199 are followed to create the response :
7200
7201 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7202 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7203 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7204 ignored.
7205
7206 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7207 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007208 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007209 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7210 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007211
7212 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7213 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7214 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007215 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007216 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007217
7218 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7219 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7220 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007221 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007222 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007223 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007224
7225 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7226 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7227 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7228 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7229 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7230 as a raw content.
7231
7232 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7233 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7234 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7235 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7236 considered as a raw string.
7237
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007238 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7239 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7240 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7241 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7242
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007243 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7244 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007245 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007246
7247 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7248
7249 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007250 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007251 if { status eq 404 }
7252
7253 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7254 string "This is the end !" \
7255 if { status eq 500 }
7256
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007257http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7258http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007259
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007260 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7261 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7262 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007263
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007264http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7265 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007266
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007267 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7268 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7269 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7270 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007271
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007272http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7273 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007274
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007275 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7276 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7277 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7278 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7279 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007280
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007281 Arguments:
7282 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007283
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007284 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7285 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007287http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007288
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007289 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7290 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7291 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007292
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007293http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7294
7295 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7296 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7297 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7298 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7299 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7300
7301http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7302
7303 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7304 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7305 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7306 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7307 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7308 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7309 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7310 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7311 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7312
7313http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7314
7315 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7316 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7317 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7318 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7319 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7320 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7321 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7322
7323http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7324
7325 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7326 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7327 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7328 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7329 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7330 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7331 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7332 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7333
7334http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7336
7337 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7338 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7339 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7340 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007341
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007342 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007343 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7344 http-response set-status 431
7345 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7346 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007347
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007348http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007349
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007350 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7351 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7352 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7353 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7354 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7355 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7356 based on some information from the request.
7357
7358 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7359
7360http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7361
7362 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7363 inline.
7364
7365 Arguments:
7366 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7367 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7368 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7369 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7370 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7371 (request and response)
7372 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7373 processing
7374 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7375 processing
7376 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7377 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7378 and '_'.
7379
7380 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7381 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007382
7383 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007384 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007385
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007386http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007387
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007388 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7389 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7390 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7391 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7392 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7393 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7394 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7395 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7396 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7397 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7398 action.
7399 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7400 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7401 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7402 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7403 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007404
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007405http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7406
7407 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7408 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7409 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7410 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7411 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007412 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007413 processing.
7414
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007415 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007416 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007417 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007418 rules evaluation.
7419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007420http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7421http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7422http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007423
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007424 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7425 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7426 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7427 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7428 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007429 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007430
7431http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7432
7433 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7434 about <var-name>.
7435
7436 Example:
7437 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7438
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007439http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7440 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7441
7442 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7443 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7444 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7445 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7446 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7447 buffer is full.
7448
7449 Arguments :
7450
7451 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7452 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7453
7454 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007455 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007456 bytes.
7457
7458 Example:
7459 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007460
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007461http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7462 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7463
7464 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7465 yes | no | yes | yes
7466
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007467 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007468 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7469 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7470 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007471
7472 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7473
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007474 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7475 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7476 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7477 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7478 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7479 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7480 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007481 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007482 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7483 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007484
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007485 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7486 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7487 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7488 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7489 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7490 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7491 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007492 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7493 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7494 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7495 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7496 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7497 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007498
7499 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7500 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7501 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7502 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7503 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7504 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7505 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7506 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007507 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007508 downsides of rare connection failures.
7509
7510 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7511 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7512 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7513 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7514 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7515 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007516 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007517 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7518 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7519 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7520 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7521 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7522
7523 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007524 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7525 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7526 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7527 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007528
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007529 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7530 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007531
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007532 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007533
7534 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7535 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7536 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7537
7538 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7539
7540
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007541http-send-name-header [<header>]
7542 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007543 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7544 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007545 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007546 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7547
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007548 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7549 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7550 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7551 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7552 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7553 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7554 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7555 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7556 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7557 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7558 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7559 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7560 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7561 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7562 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7563 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007564
7565 See also : "server"
7566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007567id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007568 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7570 no | yes | yes | yes
7571 Arguments : none
7572
7573 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7574 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7575 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007576
7577
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007578ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7579 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007581 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007582
7583 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7584 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7585 and running).
7586
7587 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7588 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7589 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007590 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007591 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7592
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007593 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7594 "unless" condition is met.
7595
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007596 Example:
7597 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7598 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7599 ignore-persist if url_static
7600
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007601 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7602
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007603load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7604 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7605 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | no | yes | yes
7607
7608 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7609 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7610 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007611 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007612 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007613 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7614 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7615 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7616
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007617 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007618 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007619 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007620
7621 Arguments:
7622 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7623 named "server-state-file".
7624
7625 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7626 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7627 name is used as a file name.
7628
7629 none don't load any stat for this backend
7630
7631 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007632 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7633 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7634 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007635 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007636 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007637
7638 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7639 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7640
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007641 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007642
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007643 global
7644 stats socket /tmp/socket
7645 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007646
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007647 defaults
7648 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007649
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007650 backend bk
7651 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7652 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007653
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007654
7655 Then one can run :
7656
7657 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7658
7659 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7660
7661 1
7662 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7663 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7664 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7665
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007666 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007667
7668 global
7669 stats socket /tmp/socket
7670 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7671
7672 defaults
7673 load-server-state-from-file local
7674
7675 backend bk
7676 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7677 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7678
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007679
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007680 Then one can run :
7681
7682 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7683
7684 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7685
7686 1
7687 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7688 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7689 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7690
7691 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7692 "show servers state"
7693
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007694
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007695log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007696log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007697 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007698no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007699 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7701 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007702
7703 Prefix :
7704 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7705 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7706 prefix does not allow arguments.
7707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007708 Arguments :
7709 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7710 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7711 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7712 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7713 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7714 parameter.
7715
7716 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7717 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7718
7719 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7720 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7721 standard syslog port).
7722
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007723 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7724 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7725 standard syslog port).
7726
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007727 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7728 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7729 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007730 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007731
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007732 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7733 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7734 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7735 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7736 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7737 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7738 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7739 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7740 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7741 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7742 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7743 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007744 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007745 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7746 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7747 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007748 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7749 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007750
7751 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7752 and "fd@2", see above.
7753
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007754 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7755 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7756 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7757 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7758 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7759 having the logs instantly available.
7760
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007761 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7762 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7763 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7764
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007765 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7766 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007767
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007768 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7769 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7770 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7771 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7772 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7773 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7774 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7775 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7776 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7777 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007778 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007779
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007780 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7781 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7782 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7783 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7784 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7785
7786 <sample_size>
7787 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7788 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7789 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7790 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7791 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7792
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007793 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7794 one of the following :
7795
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007796 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7797 field is stripped. This is the default.
7798 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7799 rfc3164.
7800
7801 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007802 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7803
7804 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7805 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7806
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007807 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7808 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7809 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7810 designed to be used with a local log server.
7811
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007812 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7813 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7814 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7815 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7816 systemd logger consumes.
7817
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007818 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7819 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7820 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7821 used with a local log server.
7822
7823 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7824 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7825 designed to be used with a local log server.
7826
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007827 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7828 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7829 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7830 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7831
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007832 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7833
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007834 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7835 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7836 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7837
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007838 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7839 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7840 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7841 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007842
7843 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7844 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7845 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007846 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7847 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7848 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7849 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7850 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007851
7852 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7853
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007854 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7855 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7856 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007857
7858 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7859 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7860 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7861 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7862
7863 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7864 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007865
7866 Example :
7867 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007868 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7869 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7870 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007871 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007872 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7873 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007874 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007876
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007877log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007878 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7880 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007881
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007882 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7883 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7884 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7885 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7886 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007887
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007888 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7889 "option httplog" directives.
7890
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007891log-format-sd <string>
7892 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7894 yes | yes | yes | no
7895
7896 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7897 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7898 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7899 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7900 which covers the log format string in depth.
7901
7902 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7903 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7904
7905 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7906 log format to "rfc5424".
7907
7908 Example :
7909 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7910
7911
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007912log-tag <string>
7913 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7914 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7915 yes | yes | yes | yes
7916
7917 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7918 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007919 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007920 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7921 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7922 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7923 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7924 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7925 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007926
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007927max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7928 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7929 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7930 yes | no | yes | yes
7931
7932 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7933 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7934 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7935 servers.
7936
7937 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007938 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007939 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7940 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7941 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007942 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007943 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7944 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7945 picking a different server.
7946
7947 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7948 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7949 even if they have to be queued.
7950
7951 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7952 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7953
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007954max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7955 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7956 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7957 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007958
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007959maxconn <conns>
7960 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7962 yes | yes | yes | no
7963 Arguments :
7964 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7965 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7966 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7967 closes.
7968
7969 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007970 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007971 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7972 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007973 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7974 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7975 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7976 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007977
7978 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7979 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7980 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7981
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007982 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7983 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007984
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007985 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7986
7987
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007988mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007989 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7991 yes | yes | yes | yes
7992 Arguments :
7993 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7994 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7995 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7996 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7997
7998 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7999 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8000 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8001 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8002 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8003
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008004 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8005 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8006 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008007
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008008 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008009 defaults http_instances
8010 mode http
8011
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008012
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008013monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008014 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8016 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008017 Arguments :
8018 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8019 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008020 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008021 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8022 backend and its backup.
8023
8024 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8025 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8026 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8027 servers in a list of backends.
8028
8029 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8030 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8031 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008032 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008033 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8034 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008035 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008036 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8037 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008038
8039 Example:
8040 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008041 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008042 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8043 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8044 monitor-uri /site_alive
8045 monitor fail if site_dead
8046
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008047 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008048
8049
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008050monitor-uri <uri>
8051 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8053 yes | yes | yes | no
8054 Arguments :
8055 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8056 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8057
8058 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8059 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8060 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8061 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8062 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8063 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8064 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8065 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8066
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008067 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008068 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8069 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8070 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8071 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8072 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8073 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008074
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008075 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8076 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8077 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8078 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8079
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008080 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008081 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008082 frontend www
8083 mode http
8084 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8085
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008086 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008087
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008088
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008089option abortonclose
8090no option abortonclose
8091 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8093 yes | no | yes | yes
8094 Arguments : none
8095
8096 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8097 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8098 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8099 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008100 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008101 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8102 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8103 encountered while delivering the response.
8104
8105 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8106 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8107 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8108 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8109 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8110 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008111 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008112 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008113 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008114 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8115 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8116 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8117
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008118 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8119 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008120 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8121 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8122 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8123 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8124 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8125 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008126 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008127
8128 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8129 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8130
8131 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8132
8133
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008134option accept-invalid-http-request
8135no option accept-invalid-http-request
8136 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8138 yes | yes | yes | no
8139 Arguments : none
8140
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008141 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008142 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008143 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008144 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8145 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8146 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8147 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8148 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008149 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8150 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8151 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8152 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008153 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008154 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008155 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8156 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8157 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008158
8159 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8160 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8161 been confirmed.
8162
8163 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8164 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008165 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8166 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008167 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8168
8169 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8170 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8171
8172 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8173 stats socket.
8174
8175
8176option accept-invalid-http-response
8177no option accept-invalid-http-response
8178 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8180 yes | no | yes | yes
8181 Arguments : none
8182
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008183 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008184 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008185 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008186 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8187 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8188 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8189 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8190 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008191 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8192 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8193 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008194
8195 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8196 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8197 been confirmed.
8198
8199 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8200 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8201 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8202 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8203
8204 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8205 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8206
8207 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8208 stats socket.
8209
8210
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008211option allbackups
8212no option allbackups
8213 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8215 yes | no | yes | yes
8216 Arguments : none
8217
8218 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8219 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8220 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8221 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8222 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8223 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8224 order between the backup servers anymore.
8225
8226 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8227 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8228
8229 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8230 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8231
8232
8233option checkcache
8234no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008235 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8237 yes | no | yes | yes
8238 Arguments : none
8239
8240 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8241 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008242 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008243 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8244 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008245 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008246
8247 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008248 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008249 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008250 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8251 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008252 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008253 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008254 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8255 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008256 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008257 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8258 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008259 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008260 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8261 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8262 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8263 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8264 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8265 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8266 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8267 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8268 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8269
8270 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008271 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8272 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8273 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8274 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008275
8276 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8277 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008278 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008279 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008280
8281 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8282 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8283
8284
8285option clitcpka
8286no option clitcpka
8287 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8289 yes | yes | yes | no
8290 Arguments : none
8291
8292 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8293 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008294 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008295 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8296
8297 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8298 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8299 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8300 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8301
8302 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8303 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8304 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8305 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8306 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8307
8308 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8309
8310 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8311 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8312 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8313
8314 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8315 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8316
8317 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8318
8319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008320option contstats
8321 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8323 yes | yes | yes | no
8324 Arguments : none
8325
8326 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8327 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8328 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008329 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008330 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8331 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8332 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8333 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8334 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008335
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008336option disable-h2-upgrade
8337no option disable-h2-upgrade
8338 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8339 connection.
8340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8341 yes | yes | yes | no
8342 Arguments : none
8343
8344 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8345 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8346 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8347 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008348 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8349 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8350 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8351 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8352 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8353 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008354
8355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008357
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008358option dontlog-normal
8359no option dontlog-normal
8360 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8362 yes | yes | yes | no
8363 Arguments : none
8364
8365 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8366 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8367 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8368 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8369 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8370 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8371 logged.
8372
8373 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8374 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8375 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008377 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008378 logging.
8379
8380
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008381option dontlognull
8382no option dontlognull
8383 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8385 yes | yes | yes | no
8386 Arguments : none
8387
8388 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8389 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8390 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8391 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8392 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8393 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008394 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8395 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8396 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008397
8398 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008399 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008400 would not be logged.
8401
8402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8404
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008405 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008406 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008407
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008408
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008409option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008410 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8412 yes | yes | yes | yes
8413 Arguments :
8414 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8415 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008416 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008417 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008418
8419 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8420 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8421 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8422 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8423 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8424 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8425 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008426 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8427 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8428 possible that the client has already brought one.
8429
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008430 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008431 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008432 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008433 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008434 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008435 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008436
8437 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8438 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8439 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8440 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8441 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8442 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008443 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008444
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008445 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8446 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008447 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008448 are under the control of the end-user.
8449
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008450 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008451 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8452 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008453 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8454 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8455 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008456
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008457 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008458 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8459 frontend www
8460 mode http
8461 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8462
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008463 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8464 backend www
8465 mode http
8466 option forwardfor header X-Client
8467
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008468 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008469 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008470
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008471
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008472option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8473no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8474 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8476 yes | yes | yes | no
8477 Arguments : none
8478
8479 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8480 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8481 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8482 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8483 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8484 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8485 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8486
8487 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8488 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8489 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8490 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8491 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8492 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8493 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8494 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8495 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8496 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8497
8498 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8499
8500 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8501 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8502
8503 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8504 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8505
8506
8507option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8508no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8509 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8511 yes | no | yes | yes
8512 Arguments : none
8513
8514 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8515 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8516 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8517 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8518 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8519 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8520 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8521
8522 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8523 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8524 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8525 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8526 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8527 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8528 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8529 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8530 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8531 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8532
8533 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8534
8535 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8536 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8537
8538 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8539 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8540
8541
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008542option http-buffer-request
8543no option http-buffer-request
8544 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8546 yes | yes | yes | yes
8547 Arguments : none
8548
8549 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8550 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8551 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8552 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8553 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8554 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008555 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8556 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8557 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8558 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008559
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008560 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8561 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008562
8563
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008564option http-ignore-probes
8565no option http-ignore-probes
8566 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8568 yes | yes | yes | no
8569 Arguments : none
8570
8571 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8572 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8573 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8574 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8575 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8576 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8577 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8578 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8579 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008580 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8581 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008582 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8583
8584 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8585 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8586 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8587 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8588 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8589 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8590 are often the only way to detect them.
8591
8592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8594
8595 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8596
8597
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008598option http-keep-alive
8599no option http-keep-alive
8600 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8602 yes | yes | yes | yes
8603 Arguments : none
8604
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008605 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8606 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008607 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8608 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008609 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8610 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8611 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008612
8613 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8614 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008615 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8616 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8617 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8618 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8619 situations where this option may be useful :
8620
8621 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008622 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008623
8624 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8625 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8626
8627 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8628 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8629 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8630 request.
8631
8632 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8633 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008634 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8635 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8636 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008637
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008638 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8639 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8640 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8641 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8642 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8643 not set.
8644
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008645 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8646 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8647 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008648
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008649 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008650 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008651 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008652
8653
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008654option http-no-delay
8655no option http-no-delay
8656 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8658 yes | yes | yes | yes
8659 Arguments : none
8660
8661 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8662 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8663 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8664 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8665 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8666 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8667 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008668 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008669 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8670 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8671 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8672 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8673 affected.
8674
8675 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8676 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8677 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8678 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8679 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8680 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8681 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8682 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8683 latency environments.
8684
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008685 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8686
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008687
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008688option http-pretend-keepalive
8689no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008690 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008692 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008693 Arguments : none
8694
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008695 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008696 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8697 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8698 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008699 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008700 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8701 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8702 consider the response complete.
8703
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008704 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008705 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008706 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008707 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008708 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008709 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8710
8711 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8712 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8713 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8714 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008715 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8716 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008717 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8718
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008719 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8720 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8721 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8722 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8723 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8724 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008725
8726 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8727 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8728
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008729 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008730 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008731
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008732option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8733 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8734 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8736 yes | yes | yes | yes
8737 Arguments :
8738 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8739 with no FastCGI application configured.
8740
8741 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8742 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8743 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8744
8745 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8746 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8747
8748 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8749 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8750 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8751 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8752 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8753 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8754 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8755 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8756
8757 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8758 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008759
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008760option http-server-close
8761no option http-server-close
8762 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8764 yes | yes | yes | yes
8765 Arguments : none
8766
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008767 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8768 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8769 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8770 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008771 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8772 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8773 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8774 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8775 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8776 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8777 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8778 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8779 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8780 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8781 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008782
8783 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8784 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8785 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8786 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008787 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8788 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008789
8790 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8791 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008792 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8793 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8794 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008795
8796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8798
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008799 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8800 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008801
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008802option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008803no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008804 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8806 yes | yes | yes | no
8807 Arguments : none
8808
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008809 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008810 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8811 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8812 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8813 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8814 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008815 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008816
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008817 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008818 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008819 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8820 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8821 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008822
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008823 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8824 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8825 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8826 front of an existing proxy.
8827
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008828 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8829
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008830 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008831
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008832option httpchk
8833option httpchk <uri>
8834option httpchk <method> <uri>
8835option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008836 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8838 yes | no | yes | yes
8839 Arguments :
8840 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8841 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8842 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8843 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8844 ones.
8845
8846 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8847 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8848 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8849
8850 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8851 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8852 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008853 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008854
8855 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8856 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8857 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8858 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8859 the lack of any response.
8860
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008861 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8862 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8863 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8864 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8865
8866 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8867 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8868 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008869
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008870 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8871 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008872 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008873 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008874 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008875
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008876 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8877 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8878 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8879 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8880
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008881 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008882 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8883 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8884 backend https_relay
8885 mode tcp
8886 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8887 http-check send hdr Host www
8888 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008889
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008890 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8891 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8892 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008893
8894
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008895option httpclose
8896no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008897 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8899 yes | yes | yes | yes
8900 Arguments : none
8901
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008902 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8903 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8904 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8905 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008906 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008907
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008908 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8909 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008910 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008911 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8912 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008913
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008914 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8915 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8916 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008917
8918 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8919 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008920 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8921 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8922 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008923
8924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8926
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008927 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008928
8929
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008930option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008931 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008933 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008934 Arguments :
8935 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8936 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8937 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008938 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008939 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008940
8941 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8942 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8943 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8944 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8945 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8946 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8947 ports.
8948
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008949 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8950 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008951
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008952 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008954 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008955
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008956
8957option http_proxy
8958no option http_proxy
8959 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8961 yes | yes | yes | yes
8962 Arguments : none
8963
8964 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8965 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8966 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8967 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8968 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8969
8970 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8971 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008972 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8973 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008974
8975 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8976 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8977
8978 Example :
8979 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8980 backend direct_forward
8981 option httpclose
8982 option http_proxy
8983
8984 See also : "option httpclose"
8985
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008986
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008987option independent-streams
8988no option independent-streams
8989 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8991 yes | yes | yes | yes
8992 Arguments : none
8993
8994 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8995 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8996 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8997 receive data or not.
8998
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008999 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009000 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9001 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9002 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9003 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9004 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9005 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9006 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9007 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9008 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9009 socket buffers.
9010
9011 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9012 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9013 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9014 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9015 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9016
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009017 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009018
9019
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009020option ldap-check
9021 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9023 yes | no | yes | yes
9024 Arguments : none
9025
9026 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9027 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9028 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9029 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9030
9031 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9032 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9033
9034 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9035 configure it.
9036
9037 Example :
9038 option ldap-check
9039
9040 See also : "option httpchk"
9041
9042
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009043option external-check
9044 Use external processes for server health checks
9045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9046 yes | no | yes | yes
9047
9048 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9049 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9050 command".
9051
9052 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9053
9054 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9055
9056
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009057option idle-close-on-response
9058no option idle-close-on-response
9059 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9061 yes | yes | yes | no
9062 Arguments : none
9063
9064 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9065 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9066 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9067 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9068 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9069 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9070 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9071 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9072 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9073
9074 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9075 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9076
9077 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9078 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9079 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9080 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9081
9082 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9083 "hard-stop-after"
9084
9085
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009086option log-health-checks
9087no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009088 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9090 yes | no | yes | yes
9091 Arguments : none
9092
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009093 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9094 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9095 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009096
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009097 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9098 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9099 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9100 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9101 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9102
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009103 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009104 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009105
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009106 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9107 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9108 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009109
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009110
9111option log-separate-errors
9112no option log-separate-errors
9113 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9115 yes | yes | yes | no
9116 Arguments : none
9117
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009118 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009119 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9120 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9121 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9122 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9123 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9124 provides very important information.
9125
9126 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9127 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9128 error logs.
9129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009130 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009131 logging.
9132
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009133
9134option logasap
9135no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009136 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9138 yes | yes | yes | no
9139 Arguments : none
9140
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009141 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9142 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9143 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9144 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9145
9146 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9147 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9148 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9149 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9150 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009151 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009152 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9153 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9154 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9155 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009156 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009157
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009158 Examples :
9159 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9160 mode http
9161 option httplog
9162 option logasap
9163 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9164
9165 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9166 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9167 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9168 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9169
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009170 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009171 logging.
9172
9173
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009174option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009175 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9177 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009178 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009179 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9180 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009181 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9182 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009183
9184 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9185 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009186 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009187 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009188 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9189 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9190 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009191
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009192 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9193 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9194 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009195
9196 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009197 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009198 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9199 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9200 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9201 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9202 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9203 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9204 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9205
9206 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9207 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009208
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009209 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009210
9211 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9212 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9213 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9214 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009215 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009216 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009217
9218 See also: "option httpchk"
9219
9220
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009221option nolinger
9222no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009223 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009224 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9225 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009226 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009227
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009228 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009229 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9230 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9231 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9232 connections.
9233
9234 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9235 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009236 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9237 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9238 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9239 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9240 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9241 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9242 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9243 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9244 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9245 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9246 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9247 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9248 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009249
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009250 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9251 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9252 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9253 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9254 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009255
9256 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9257 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009258 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009259 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009260 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009261
9262 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9263 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9264
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009265 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9266 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009267
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009268option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9269 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9271 yes | yes | yes | yes
9272 Arguments :
9273 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9274 matching <network>
9275 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9276 header name.
9277
9278 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9279 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9280 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9281 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9282 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9283 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9284 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9285 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9286 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9287 possible that the client has already brought one.
9288
9289 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9290 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9291 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9292 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9293 header and requires different one.
9294
9295 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9296 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9297 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009298 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9299 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9300 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9301 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9302 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009303
9304 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9305 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9306 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9307 both are defined.
9308
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009309 Examples :
9310 # Original Destination address
9311 frontend www
9312 mode http
9313 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9314
9315 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9316 backend www
9317 mode http
9318 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9319
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009320 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009321
9322
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009323option persist
9324no option persist
9325 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9326 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9327 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009328 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009329
9330 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9331 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9332 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9333 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9334 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9335 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9336 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9337 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9338 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9339 redirected to another valid server.
9340
9341 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9342 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9343
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009344 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009345
9346
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009347option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9348 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9350 yes | no | yes | yes
9351 Arguments :
9352 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9353 PostgreSQL server.
9354
9355 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9356 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9357 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9358 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9359
9360 See also: "option httpchk"
9361
9362
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009363option prefer-last-server
9364no option prefer-last-server
9365 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9366 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9367 yes | no | yes | yes
9368 Arguments : none
9369
9370 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009371 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009372 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9373 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009374 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009375 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009376 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009377 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9378 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009379 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009380 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009381 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9382 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9383 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009384 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9385 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9386 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009387
9388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9390
9391 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9392
9393
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009394option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009395option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009396no option redispatch
9397 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9399 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009400 Arguments :
9401 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9402 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9403 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009404 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009405 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009406 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009407 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9408 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9409 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009411
9412 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9413 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9414 be able to access the service anymore.
9415
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009416 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9417 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009418
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009419 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9420 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9421 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9422 following order:
9423
9424 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9425
9426 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9427 list, or
9428
9429 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9430
9431 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9432 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9433
9434 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9435 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9436 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9437 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9438
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009439 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009440 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9441 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009442
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009443 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9444 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9445
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009446 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009447
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009448
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009449option redis-check
9450 Use redis health checks for server testing
9451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9452 yes | no | yes | yes
9453 Arguments : none
9454
9455 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9456 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9457 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9458 find the "+PONG" response message.
9459
9460 Example :
9461 option redis-check
9462
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009463 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009464
9465
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009466option smtpchk
9467option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9468 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9470 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009471 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009472 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009473 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009474 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9475
9476 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9477 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9478 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9479
9480 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9481 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9482 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9483 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9484 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9485 dead server.
9486
9487 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9488 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009489 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009490 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9491
9492 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9493 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9494 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9495 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009496 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009497
9498 Example :
9499 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9500
9501 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009504option socket-stats
9505no option socket-stats
9506
9507 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9509 yes | yes | yes | no
9510
9511 Arguments : none
9512
9513
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009514option splice-auto
9515no option splice-auto
9516 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9518 yes | yes | yes | yes
9519 Arguments : none
9520
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009521 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009522 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009523 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009524 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009525 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009526 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9527 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9528 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9529 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9530
9531 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9532 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9533 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9534 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9535 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9536 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9537 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9538 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9539 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9540 keyword.
9541
9542 Example :
9543 option splice-auto
9544
9545 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9546 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9547
9548 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9549 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9550
9551
9552option splice-request
9553no option splice-request
9554 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9556 yes | yes | yes | yes
9557 Arguments : none
9558
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009559 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009560 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009561 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9562 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9563 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9564 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9565
9566 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9567
9568 Example :
9569 option splice-request
9570
9571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9573
9574 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9575 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9576
9577
9578option splice-response
9579no option splice-response
9580 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9582 yes | yes | yes | yes
9583 Arguments : none
9584
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009585 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009586 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009587 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9588 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9589 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9590 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9591
9592 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9593
9594 Example :
9595 option splice-response
9596
9597 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9598 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9599
9600 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9601 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9602
9603
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009604option spop-check
9605 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9607 no | no | no | yes
9608 Arguments : none
9609
9610 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9611 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9612 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9613 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9614
9615 Example :
9616 option spop-check
9617
9618 See also : "option httpchk"
9619
9620
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009621option srvtcpka
9622no option srvtcpka
9623 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9625 yes | no | yes | yes
9626 Arguments : none
9627
9628 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9629 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009630 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009631 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9632
9633 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9634 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9635 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9636 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9637
9638 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9639 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9640 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9641 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9642 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9643
9644 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9645
9646 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9647 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9648 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9649
9650 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9651 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9652
9653 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9654
9655
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009656option ssl-hello-chk
9657 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9659 yes | no | yes | yes
9660 Arguments : none
9661
9662 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9663 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9664 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9665 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9666 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9667 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9668 hello message.
9669
9670 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9671 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9672 messages, which is appreciable.
9673
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009674 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009675 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9676 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009677
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009678 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9679
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009680
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009681option tcp-check
9682 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9684 yes | no | yes | yes
9685
9686 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9687 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9688
9689 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9690 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9691 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9692
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009693 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009694 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9695 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9696 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9697 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9698 only.
9699
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009700 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009701 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009702 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9703 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9704 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9705
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009706 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009707 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9708 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009709 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009710 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9711 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9712 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9713 the respective protocols.
9714 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009715 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009716
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009717 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009718
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009719 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9720 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9721 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9722 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009723
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009724 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9725 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9726 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009727
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009728
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009729 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009730 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009731 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009732 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009733
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009734 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009735 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009736 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009737
9738 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9739 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009740 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009741 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009742 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009743 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009744 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009745 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009746 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9747 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009748 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009749 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9750 tcp-check expect string +OK
9751
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009752 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009753 (send many headers before analyzing)
9754 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009755 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009756 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9757 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9758 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9759 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009760 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009761
9762
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009763 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009764
9765
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009766option tcp-smart-accept
9767no option tcp-smart-accept
9768 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9770 yes | yes | yes | no
9771 Arguments : none
9772
9773 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9774 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9775 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9776 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9777 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9778 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9779
9780 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9781 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9782 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9783 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9784
9785 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9786 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9787 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009788 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009789
9790 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9791 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9792 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9793
9794 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9795 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9796 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9797
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009798 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9799
9800
9801option tcp-smart-connect
9802no option tcp-smart-connect
9803 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9805 yes | no | yes | yes
9806 Arguments : none
9807
9808 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9809 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9810 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9811 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9812 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9813
9814 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9815 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9816 complex.
9817
9818 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9819 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9820 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9821
9822 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9823 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9824
9825 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9826
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009827
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009828option tcpka
9829 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9831 yes | yes | yes | yes
9832 Arguments : none
9833
9834 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9835 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009836 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009837 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9838
9839 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9840 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9841 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9842 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9843
9844 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9845 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9846 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9847 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9848 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9849
9850 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9851
9852 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9853 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9854 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9855 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9856 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9857 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9858 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9859 backends.
9860
9861 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9862
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009863
9864option tcplog
9865 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009867 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009868 Arguments : none
9869
9870 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9871 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9872 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9873 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9874 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9875 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9876 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9877 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9878
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009879 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009881 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009882
9883
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009884option transparent
9885no option transparent
9886 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009888 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009889 Arguments : none
9890
9891 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9892 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9893 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9894 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9895 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9896 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9897 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9898 appropriate server.
9899
9900 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9901 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9902
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009903 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009904 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009905
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009906
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009907external-check command <command>
9908 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9910 yes | no | yes | yes
9911
9912 Arguments :
9913 <command> is the external command to run
9914
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009915 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9916
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009917 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009918
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009919 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9920 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9921 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9922 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9923 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9924 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009925
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009926 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9927
9928 Environment variables :
9929 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9930 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9931
9932 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9933
9934 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9935
9936 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9937 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9938 for a UNIX socket).
9939
9940 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9941
9942 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9943
9944 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9945
9946 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9947
9948 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9949
9950 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9951 socket).
9952
9953 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9954 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9955
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009956 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9957
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009958 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9959 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9960 failed.
9961
9962 Example :
9963 external-check command /bin/true
9964
9965 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9966
9967
9968external-check path <path>
9969 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9971 yes | no | yes | yes
9972
9973 Arguments :
9974 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9975
9976 The default path is "".
9977
9978 Example :
9979 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9980
9981 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9982 "external-check command"
9983
9984
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009985persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009986persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009987 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9989 yes | no | yes | yes
9990 Arguments :
9991 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009992 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9993 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009994
9995 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9996 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009997 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009998 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9999 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10000 forwarded to this server.
10001
10002 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10003 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10004 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010005 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010006 a single "listen" section.
10007
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010008 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10009 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10010 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10011
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010012 Example :
10013 listen tse-farm
10014 bind :3389
10015 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10016 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10017 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10018 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10019 persist rdp-cookie
10020 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010021 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010022 balance rdp-cookie
10023 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10024 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10025
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010026 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010027
10028
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010029rate-limit sessions <rate>
10030 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10032 yes | yes | yes | no
10033 Arguments :
10034 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10035 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10036
10037 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10038 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10039 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010040 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010041 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10042 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10043
10044 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10045 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10046 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10047 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10048
10049 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10050 listen smtp
10051 mode tcp
10052 bind :25
10053 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010054 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010055
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010056 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10057 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10058 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010059
10060 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10061
10062
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010063redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10064redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10065redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010066 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10068 no | yes | yes | yes
10069
10070 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010071 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010072
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010073 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010074 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010075 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10076 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10077 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010078
10079 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10080 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10081 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10082 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10083 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010084 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10085 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10086 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10087 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010088
10089 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10090 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10091 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10092 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10093 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10094 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010095 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010096 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010097 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10098 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10099 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010100
10101 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010102 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10103 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10104 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010105 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010106 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10107 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10108 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10109 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010110
10111 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010112 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010113
10114 - "drop-query"
10115 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10116 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10117 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10118 with a location-type redirect.
10119
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010120 - "append-slash"
10121 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10122 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10123 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10124 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10125
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010126 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10127 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10128 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10129 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10130 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10131 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10132 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10133
10134 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10135 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10136 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10137 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10138 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10139 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10140 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010141
10142 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10143 acl clear dst_port 80
10144 acl secure dst_port 8080
10145 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010146 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010147 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010148 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10149
10150 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010151 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10152 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10153 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010154 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010155
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010156 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10157 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10158 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10159
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010160 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010161 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010162
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010163 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010164 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10165 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10166 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010168 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010169
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010170
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010171retries <value>
10172 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10173 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10174 yes | no | yes | yes
10175 Arguments :
10176 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10177 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10178 default value is 3.
10179
10180 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10181 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10182 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10183
10184 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010185 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10186 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010187
10188 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10189 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10190
10191 See also : "option redispatch"
10192
10193
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010194retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010195 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10196 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10197 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010198 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10199 yes | no | yes | yes
10200 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010201 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10202 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10203 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10204 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10205 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010206
10207 none never retry
10208
10209 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10210 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10211
10212 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10213 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10214 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10215 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10216 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10217 processing the request.
10218
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010219 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10220 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10221 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10222 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10223 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10224 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10225 overflow attack for example).
10226
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010227 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10228 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10229 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10230 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10231 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10232 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10233 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10234 amplify denial of service attacks.
10235
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010236 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10237 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10238 considered to be safe to retry.
10239
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010240 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10241 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10242 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10243 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10244 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010245
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010246 all-retryable-errors
10247 retry request for any error that are considered
10248 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10249 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10250 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10251
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010252 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10253 not cumulative.
10254
10255 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10256 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10257 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10258 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10259
10260 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10261 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10262 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10263 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10264 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10265 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10266 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10267 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10268 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10269 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10270 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10271 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10272
10273 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10274 should not use this directive.
10275
10276 The default is "conn-failure".
10277
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010278 Example:
10279 retry-on 503 504
10280
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010281 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10282
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010283server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010284 Declare a server in a backend
10285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10286 no | no | yes | yes
10287 Arguments :
10288 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010289 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010290 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010291
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010292 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10293 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10294 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10295 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010296 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10297 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010298 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010299 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10300 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010301 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10302 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10303 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10304 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10305 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10306 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10307 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010308 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010309 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10310 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10311 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10312 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10313 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10314 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010315 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10316 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010317 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10318 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010319
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010320 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010321 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10322 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10323 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10324 adding this value to the client's port.
10325
10326 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10327 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010328 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010329
10330 Examples :
10331 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10332 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010333 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010334 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10335 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10336 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010337
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010338 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10339 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10340 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10341 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10342 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10343
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010344 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10345 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010346
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010347server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010348 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010349 this backend.
10350 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10351 no | no | yes | yes
10352
10353 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10354 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10355 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10356 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10357 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010358
10359 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10360 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10361
10362 global
10363 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10364
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010365 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010366 load-server-state-from-file
10367
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010368 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010369 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010370
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010371server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10372 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10373 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10375 no | no | yes | yes
10376
10377 Arguments:
10378 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10379
10380 <num | range>
10381 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10382 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10383 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10384 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10385
10386 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10387
10388 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10389
10390 <params*>
10391 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10392 keyword.
10393
10394 Examples:
10395 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10396 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10397 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10398
10399 # or
10400 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10401
10402 # would be equivalent to:
10403 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10404 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10405 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10406
10407
10408
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010409source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010410source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010411source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010412 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10414 yes | no | yes | yes
10415 Arguments :
10416 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10417 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010418
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010419 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010420 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10421 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10422 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10423 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10424 supported prefixes are :
10425 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10426 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10427 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010428 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010429 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10430 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010431
10432 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10433 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010434 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10435 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10436 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010437
10438 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10439 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10440 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10441 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10442 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10443 <addr>.
10444
10445 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10446 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10447 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10448 port.
10449
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010450 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10451 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10452 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10453 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010454 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010455 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10456 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10457 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10458 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10459 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10460 HTTP header.
10461
10462 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10463 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010464 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010465 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10466 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10467 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10468 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10469 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10470 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10471 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10472
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010473 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10474 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10475 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10476 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10477 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10478 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10479
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010480 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10481 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10482 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10483 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10484
10485 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10486 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10487 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10488 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10489 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10490 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10491
10492 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10493 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10494 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10495 there are two methods :
10496
10497 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10498 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10499 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10500 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10501 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10502 of the client ranges may be used.
10503
10504 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10505 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10506 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10507 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10508 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10509 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10510 same session.
10511
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010512 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10513 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10514 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010515 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010516
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010517 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10518
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010519 Examples :
10520 backend private
10521 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10522 source 192.168.1.200
10523
10524 backend transparent_ssl1
10525 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10526 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10527
10528 backend transparent_ssl2
10529 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10530 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10531 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10532
10533 backend transparent_ssl3
10534 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10535 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10536 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10537
10538 backend transparent_smtp
10539 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10540 # with Tproxy version 4.
10541 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10542
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010543 backend transparent_http
10544 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10545 # proxy.
10546 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010548 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010549 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10550
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010551
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010552srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10553 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10554 the connection on the server side.
10555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10556 yes | no | yes | yes
10557 Arguments :
10558 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10559
10560 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10561 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010562 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10563 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010564
10565 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10566
10567
10568srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10569 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10570 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10571 server side.
10572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10573 yes | no | yes | yes
10574 Arguments :
10575 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10576 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10577 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10578 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10579
10580 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10581 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010582 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10583 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010584
10585 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10586
10587
10588srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10589 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10591 yes | no | yes | yes
10592 Arguments :
10593 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10594 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10595 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10596 document.
10597
10598 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10599 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010600 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10601 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010602
10603 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10604
10605
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010606stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10607 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010609 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010610
10611 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10612 matched.
10613
10614 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10615 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10616
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010617 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10618 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010619 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010620
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010621 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10622 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10623 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10624 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010625
10626 Example :
10627 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10628 backend stats_localhost
10629 stats enable
10630 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10631
10632 Example :
10633 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10634 backend stats_auth
10635 stats enable
10636 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10637 stats admin if TRUE
10638
10639 Example :
10640 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10641 userlist stats-auth
10642 group admin users admin
10643 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10644 group readonly users haproxy
10645 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10646
10647 backend stats_auth
10648 stats enable
10649 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10650 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10651 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10652 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10653
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010654 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10655 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10656 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010657
10658
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010659stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10660 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010662 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010663 Arguments :
10664 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10665
10666 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10667
10668 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10669 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10670 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10671 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10672 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10673 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10674
10675 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10676 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10677 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010678 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010679
10680 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10681 report using "stats scope".
10682
10683 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10684 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10685 unobvious parameters.
10686
10687 Example :
10688 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10689 backend public_www
10690 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10691 stats enable
10692 stats hide-version
10693 stats scope .
10694 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010695 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010696 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10697 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10698
10699 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10700 backend private_monitoring
10701 stats enable
10702 stats uri /admin?stats
10703 stats refresh 5s
10704
10705 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10706
10707
10708stats enable
10709 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010711 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010712 Arguments : none
10713
10714 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10715 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10716 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10717 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10718 - stats auth : no authentication
10719 - stats scope : no restriction
10720
10721 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10722 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10723 unobvious parameters.
10724
10725 Example :
10726 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10727 backend public_www
10728 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10729 stats enable
10730 stats hide-version
10731 stats scope .
10732 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010733 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010734 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10735 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10736
10737 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10738 backend private_monitoring
10739 stats enable
10740 stats uri /admin?stats
10741 stats refresh 5s
10742
10743 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10744
10745
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010746stats hide-version
10747 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010749 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010750 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010751
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010752 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10753 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10754 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10755 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10756 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10757 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010759 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10760 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10761 unobvious parameters.
10762
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010763 Example :
10764 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10765 backend public_www
10766 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010767 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010768 stats hide-version
10769 stats scope .
10770 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010771 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010772 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10773 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010774
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010775 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10776 backend private_monitoring
10777 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010778 stats uri /admin?stats
10779 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010780
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010781 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010782
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010783
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010784stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10785 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10786 Access control for statistics
10787
10788 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10789 no | no | yes | yes
10790
10791 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10792 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10793 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10794 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10795 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10796 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10797
10798 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10799 instance.
10800
10801 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10802 about ACL usage.
10803
10804
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010805stats realm <realm>
10806 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010808 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010809 Arguments :
10810 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10811 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10812 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10813
10814 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10815 using a backslash ('\').
10816
10817 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10818 only related to authentication.
10819
10820 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10821 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10822 unobvious parameters.
10823
10824 Example :
10825 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10826 backend public_www
10827 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10828 stats enable
10829 stats hide-version
10830 stats scope .
10831 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010832 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010833 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10834 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10835
10836 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10837 backend private_monitoring
10838 stats enable
10839 stats uri /admin?stats
10840 stats refresh 5s
10841
10842 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10843
10844
10845stats refresh <delay>
10846 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010848 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010849 Arguments :
10850 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10851 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10852 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10853 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10854 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10855 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10856
10857 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10858 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10859 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010860 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010861
10862 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10863 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10864 unobvious parameters.
10865
10866 Example :
10867 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10868 backend public_www
10869 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10870 stats enable
10871 stats hide-version
10872 stats scope .
10873 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010874 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010875 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10876 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10877
10878 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10879 backend private_monitoring
10880 stats enable
10881 stats uri /admin?stats
10882 stats refresh 5s
10883
10884 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10885
10886
10887stats scope { <name> | "." }
10888 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010890 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010891 Arguments :
10892 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10893 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10894 section in which the statement appears.
10895
10896 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10897 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10898 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10899 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10900 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10901 exists.
10902
10903 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10904 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10905 unobvious parameters.
10906
10907 Example :
10908 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10909 backend public_www
10910 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10911 stats enable
10912 stats hide-version
10913 stats scope .
10914 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010915 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010916 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10917 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10918
10919 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10920 backend private_monitoring
10921 stats enable
10922 stats uri /admin?stats
10923 stats refresh 5s
10924
10925 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10926
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010927
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010928stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010929 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010931 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010932
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010933 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010934 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10935
10936 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10937 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10938
10939 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10940 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010941 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010942
10943 Example :
10944 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10945 backend private_monitoring
10946 stats enable
10947 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10948 stats uri /admin?stats
10949 stats refresh 5s
10950
10951 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10952 global section.
10953
10954
10955stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010956 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10958 yes | yes | yes | yes
10959 Arguments : none
10960
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010961 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010962 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10963 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10964 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10965 - IP (socket, server)
10966 - cookie (backend, server)
10967
10968 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10969 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010970 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010971
10972 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10973
10974
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010975stats show-modules
10976 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10978 yes | yes | yes | yes
10979 Arguments : none
10980
10981 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10982 values as a tooltip.
10983
10984 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10985 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10986 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10987
10988 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10989
10990
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010991stats show-node [ <name> ]
10992 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010994 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010995 Arguments:
10996 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10997 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10998
10999 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11000 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011001 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011002
11003 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11004 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11005 unobvious parameters.
11006
11007 Example:
11008 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11009 backend private_monitoring
11010 stats enable
11011 stats show-node Europe-1
11012 stats uri /admin?stats
11013 stats refresh 5s
11014
11015 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11016 section.
11017
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011018
11019stats uri <prefix>
11020 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011022 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011023 Arguments :
11024 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11025 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11026 query string.
11027
11028 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11029 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11030 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11031 possible to reach it in the application.
11032
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011033 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011034 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011035 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11036 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11037 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11038 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11039
11040 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11041 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11042 an address or a port to statistics only.
11043
11044 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11045 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11046 unobvious parameters.
11047
11048 Example :
11049 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11050 backend public_www
11051 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11052 stats enable
11053 stats hide-version
11054 stats scope .
11055 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011056 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011057 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11058 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11059
11060 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11061 backend private_monitoring
11062 stats enable
11063 stats uri /admin?stats
11064 stats refresh 5s
11065
11066 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11067
11068
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011069stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11070 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011072 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011073
11074 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011075 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011076 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011077 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011078 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11079
11080 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11081 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11082 the "stick-table" statement.
11083
11084 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11085 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11086 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11087 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11088 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11089
11090 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11091 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11092 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11093 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11094 transformation rules.
11095
11096 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11097 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11098 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11099 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11100 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11101 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11102 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11103
11104 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11105 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11106 ACL based conditions.
11107
11108 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11109 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11110 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11111 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11112
11113 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11114 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11115 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11116 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11117
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011118 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11119 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011120 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011121
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011122 Example :
11123 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11124 # last 30 minutes
11125 backend pop
11126 mode tcp
11127 balance roundrobin
11128 stick store-request src
11129 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11130 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11131 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11132
11133 backend smtp
11134 mode tcp
11135 balance roundrobin
11136 stick match src table pop
11137 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11138 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11139
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011140 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011141 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011142
11143
11144stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11145 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11147 no | no | yes | yes
11148
11149 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11150 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11151 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11152 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11153
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011154 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11155 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011156 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011157
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011158 Examples :
11159 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011160 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011161
11162 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11163 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11164 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11165
11166
11167 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11168 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11169 backend http
11170 mode http
11171 balance roundrobin
11172 stick on src table https
11173 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11174 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11175 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11176
11177 backend https
11178 mode tcp
11179 balance roundrobin
11180 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11181 stick on src
11182 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11183 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11184
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011185 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011186
11187
11188stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11189 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11191 no | no | yes | yes
11192
11193 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011194 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011195 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011196 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011197 server is selected.
11198
11199 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11200 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11201 the "stick-table" statement.
11202
11203 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11204 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11205 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11206 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11207 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11208 address.
11209
11210 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11211 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11212 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11213 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11214 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11215 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11216 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11217 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11218 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11219 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11220
11221 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11222 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11223 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11224 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11225 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11226 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11227 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11228
11229 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11230 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11231 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11232 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11233
11234 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11235 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11236 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11237 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11238 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11239 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011240 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11241 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11242 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11243 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11244 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11245 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011246
11247 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11248 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11249 the request.
11250
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011251 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11252 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011253 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011254
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011255 Example :
11256 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11257 # last 30 minutes
11258 backend pop
11259 mode tcp
11260 balance roundrobin
11261 stick store-request src
11262 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11263 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11264 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11265
11266 backend smtp
11267 mode tcp
11268 balance roundrobin
11269 stick match src table pop
11270 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11271 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11272
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011273 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011274 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011275
11276
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011277stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011278 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011279 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011280 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011282 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011283
11284 Arguments :
11285 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11286 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11287 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11288 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11289
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011290 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11291 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11292 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11293 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11294
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011295 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11296 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11297 instance.
11298
11299 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11300 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11301 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11302 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11303 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11304 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011305 to 32 characters.
11306
11307 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11308 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11309 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011310 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011311 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11312 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011313
11314 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011315 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11316 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011317 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11318 increase.
11319
11320 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011321 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11322 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11323 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011324
11325 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011326 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011327 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11328 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011329 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011330 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11331 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11332 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11333 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11334 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11335 parameter (see below).
11336
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011337 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11338 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11339 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11340 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11341 soft restart.
11342
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011343 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11344 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011345
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011346 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11347 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11348 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11349 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011350 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011351 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011352 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11353 if not expiration delay is specified.
11354
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011355 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11356 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11357 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11358 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11359 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11360 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11361 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11362 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11363 token.
11364
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011365 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11366 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11367 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11368 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011369 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11370 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11371 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11372 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11373 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11374 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11375 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11376 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11377 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11378 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11379 types and their arguments.
11380
11381 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11382 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11383 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11384 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11385
11386 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11387 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11388 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011389 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011390
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011391 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11392 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11393 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011394 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011395 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011396 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011397
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011398 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11399 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11400 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11401 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11402
11403 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11404 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11405 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11406 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11407 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11408 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11409
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011410 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11411 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11412 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11413 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11414
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011415 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11416 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11417 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11418 they were received.
11419
11420 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11421 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11422 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11423 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11424 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11425
11426 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11427 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11428 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11429 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11430 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11431
11432 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11433 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11434 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11435
11436 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11437 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11438 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11439 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11440 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11441
11442 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11443 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11444 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11445 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11446 the client side.
11447
11448 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11449 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11450 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11451 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11452 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11453 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11454 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11455
11456 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11457 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11458 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11459 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11460 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11461 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011462 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011463
11464 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11465 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11466 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11467 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11468 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11469 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11470
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011471 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11472 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11473 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11474 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11475 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11476
11477 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11478 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11479 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11480 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11481 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11482 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11483
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011484 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011485 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011486 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11487 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11488
11489 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11490 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11491 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11492 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11493 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11494 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11495 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11496 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11497 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11498 recommended for better fairness.
11499
11500 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011501 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011502 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11503 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11504
11505 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11506 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11507 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11508 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11509 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11510 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11511 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11512 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11513 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11514 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011515
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011516 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11517 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011518 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11519 reference it.
11520
11521 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11522 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011523 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11524 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11525 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011526
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011527 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11528 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11529 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11530 something that can be ignored.
11531
11532 Example:
11533 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11534 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11535 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11536 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11537
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011538 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011539 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011540
11541
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011542stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011543 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11545 no | no | yes | yes
11546
11547 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011548 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011549 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011550 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011551 server is selected.
11552
11553 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11554 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11555 the "stick-table" statement.
11556
11557 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11558 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11559 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11560 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11561
11562 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11563 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11564 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11565 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11566 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11567 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011568 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011569 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11570 rules.
11571
11572 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11573 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11574 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11575 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11576 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11577 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11578 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11579
11580 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11581 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11582 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11583 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11584
11585 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11586 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11587 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11588 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11589 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11590 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011591 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11592 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11593 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11594 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11595 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11596 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11597 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11598 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11599 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011600
11601 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11602
11603 Example :
11604 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11605 backend https
11606 mode tcp
11607 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011608 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011609 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011610
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011611 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11612 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011613
11614 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11615 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11616 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11617
11618 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11619 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011620
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011621 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11622 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11623 # at offset 44.
11624
11625 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011626 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011627
11628 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011629 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011630
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011631 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11632 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11633
11634 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11635 extraction.
11636
11637
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011638tcp-check comment <string>
11639 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11640 it fails.
11641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11642 yes | no | yes | yes
11643
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011644 Arguments :
11645 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11646 rule fails.
11647
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011648 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11649 user-friendly error reporting.
11650
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011651 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11652 "tcp-check expect".
11653
11654
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011655tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11656 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011657 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011658 Opens a new connection
11659 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011660 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011661
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011662 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011663 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11664
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011665 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011666 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011667
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011668 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011669 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11670 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011671 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011672
11673 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011674
11675 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11676
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011677 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11678
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011679 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11680
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011681 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11682
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011683 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11684 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11685 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11686 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11687
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011688 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11689 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11690 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11691 haproxy -vv.
11692
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011693 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011694
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011695 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11696 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11697 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11698
11699 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11700 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11701 of the sequence.
11702
11703 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11704 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11705 do.
11706
11707 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11708 unset-var or comment rules.
11709
11710 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011711 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11712 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11713 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11714 option tcp-check
11715 tcp-check connect
11716 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11717 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11718 tcp-check send \r\n
11719 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11720 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11721 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11722 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11723 tcp-check send \r\n
11724 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11725 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11726
11727 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11728 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011729 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011730 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11731 tcp-check connect port 143
11732 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11733 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11734
11735 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11736
11737
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011738tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011739 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011740 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011741 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011742 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011743 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011744 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011745
11746 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011747 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11748
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011749 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11750 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11751 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11752 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11753 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11754 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11755 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11756 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11757 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11758 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11759
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011760 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011761 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11762 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011763 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11764 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11765 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11766
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011767 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11768 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11769 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011770 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11771 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011772 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11773 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011774 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11775 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011776 By default "L7OK" is used.
11777
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011778 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11779 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011780 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11781 supported :
11782 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11783 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011784 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11785 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11786 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11787 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11788 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011789
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011790 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011791 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011792 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11793 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11794 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11795 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011796 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11797
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011798 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11799 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11800 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11801 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11802
11803 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11804 informational message reported in logs if an error
11805 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11806 log-format string.
11807
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011808 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11809 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11810 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11811 followed by some converters.
11812
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011813 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11814 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11815 with the usual backslash ('\').
11816 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011817 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011818 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11819 used upper or lower case.
11820
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011821 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11822
11823 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11824 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11825 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11826 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11827 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11828 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11829 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11830 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11831
11832 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11833 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11834 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11835 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11836 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11837 expression.
11838
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011839 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11840 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11841 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11842 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11843 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11844 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11845
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011846 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11847 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11848 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11849 this exact hexadecimal string.
11850 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11851
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011852 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11853 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11854 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11855 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11856 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11857 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11858 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11859 size.
11860
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011861 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11862 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11863 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11864 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11865 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11866 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11867 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11868 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11869 in a binary string before matching the response's
11870 buffer.
11871
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011872 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011873 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011874 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11875 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11876 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11877 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11878 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11879 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11880 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11881 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11882 the null character.
11883
11884 Examples :
11885 # perform a POP check
11886 option tcp-check
11887 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11888
11889 # perform an IMAP check
11890 option tcp-check
11891 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11892
11893 # look for the redis master server
11894 option tcp-check
11895 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011896 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011897 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11898 tcp-check expect string role:master
11899 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11900 tcp-check expect string +OK
11901
11902
11903 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011904 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011905
11906
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011907tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11908tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11909 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11910 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011911 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011912 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011913
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011914 Arguments :
11915 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11916
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011917 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11918 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011919
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011920 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11921 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011922
11923 Examples :
11924 # look for the redis master server
11925 option tcp-check
11926 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11927 tcp-check expect string role:master
11928
11929 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011930 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011931
11932
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011933tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11934tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11935 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11936 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011937 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011938 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011939
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011940 Arguments :
11941 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011942
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011943 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11944 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011945
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011946 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11947 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11948 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011949
11950 Examples :
11951 # redis check in binary
11952 option tcp-check
11953 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11954 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11955
11956
11957 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011958 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011959
11960
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011961tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011962 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011964 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011965
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011966 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011967 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11968 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11969 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11970 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11971 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11972 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11973 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11974 and '-'.
11975
11976 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11977
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011978 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011979 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11980
11981
11982tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011983 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011984 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011985 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011986
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011987 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011988 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11989 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11990 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11991 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11992 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11993 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11994 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11995 and '-'.
11996
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011997 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011998 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11999
12000
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012001tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12002 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12004 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012005 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012006 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12007 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012008
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012009 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012010
12011 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12012 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012013 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12014 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12015 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12016 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12017 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12018 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012020 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12021 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12022 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12023 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012024
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012025 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012026 - accept :
12027 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12028 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12029 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012030
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012031 - reject :
12032 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12033 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12034 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12035 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12036 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12037 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12038 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12039 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12040 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12041 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12042 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012043 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012044
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012045 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12046 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12047 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12048 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12049 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12050 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12051 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12052 hosts.
12053
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012054 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12055 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12056 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12057 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12058 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12059 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12060 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12061 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12062
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012063 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12064 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12065 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12066 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12067 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12068 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12069 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12070 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12071 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012072 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12073 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012074
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012075 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012076 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012077 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12078 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12079 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012080 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012081 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012082 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12083 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12084 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12085 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12086 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12087 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12088 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012089
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012090 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012091 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012092 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012093 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012094 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12095 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12096 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012097
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012098 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12099 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12100 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12101 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012102
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012103 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12104 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12105 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12106 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12107 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012108 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12109 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12110 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12111 layer7 information is extracted.
12112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012113 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12114 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12115 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12116 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12117 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012118
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012119 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12120 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12121 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12122 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12123
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012124 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12125 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12126 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12127 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12128
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012129 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12130 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12131 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12132 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12133 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012134
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012135 - set-src <expr> :
12136 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12137 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12138 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012139 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012141 Arguments:
12142 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12143 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012144
12145 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012146 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12147
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012148 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12149 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012150
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012151 - set-src-port <expr> :
12152 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12153 expression.
12154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012155 Arguments:
12156 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12157 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012158
12159 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012160 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12161
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012162 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12163 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12164 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012165
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012166 - set-dst <expr> :
12167 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12168 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12169 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12170 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12171 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12172
12173 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12174 followed by some converters.
12175
12176 Example:
12177
12178 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12179 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12180
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012181 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12182 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12183
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012184 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12185 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12186 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12187 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12188
12189
12190 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12191 followed by some converters.
12192
12193 Example:
12194
12195 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12196
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012197 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12198 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12199 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12200
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012201 - "silent-drop" :
12202 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012203 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012204 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12205 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12206 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12207 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12208 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012209 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12210 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012211 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12212 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012213 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012214 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12215 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12216 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12217 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12218
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012219 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12220 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12221 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012222
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012223 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12224 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12225 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012227 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012228 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012229 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012230
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012231 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12232 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12233 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012234
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012235 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012236 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12237 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012238
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012239 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12240
12241 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12242
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012243 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12244
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012245 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012246
12247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012248tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12249 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012251 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012252 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012253 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12254 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012255
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012256 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012257
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012258 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012259 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12260 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012261 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12262 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012263
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012264 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12265 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12266 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12267 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012268 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012269 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012270 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12271 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12272 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12273 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012274 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012275 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012276
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012277 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12278 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12279 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12280 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012281
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012282 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012283 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012284 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012285 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12286 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012287 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012288 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012289 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012290 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012291 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012292 - set-dst <expr>
12293 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012294 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012295 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012296 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012297 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012298 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012299 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012300
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012301 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12302 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012303 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12304 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012305
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012306 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12307 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12308 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12309 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12310 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12311 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012312
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012313 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012314 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12315 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012316
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012317 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12318 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12319 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12320 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12321 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12322 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12323
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012324 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012325 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12326 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12327 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12328 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12329 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12330 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12331 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12332 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12333 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12334 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012335
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012336 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012337 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12338 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12339 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012340
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012341 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12342 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12343
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012344 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012345 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12346 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012347
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012348 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12349 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012350 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012351 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12352 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012353 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012354 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012355 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012356 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12357 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012358 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012359 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12360 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012361
12362 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12363 followed by some converters.
12364
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012365 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012366 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12367 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12368 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12369 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12370 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12371 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012372 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012373 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12374 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12375
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012376 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12377
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012378 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12379 <var-name>.
12380
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012381 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12382 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12383 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12384 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12385 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12386
12387 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12388 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12389 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12390 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12391 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12392 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12393 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12394 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12395 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12396 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12397 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12398
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012399 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12400 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12401 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12402 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12403 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12404
12405 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12406
12407 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12408
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012409 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12410 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12411 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12412 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12413 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12414 evaluated.
12415
12416 Example:
12417 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12418
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012419 Example:
12420
12421 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012422 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012423
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012424 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012425 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012426 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012427 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12428 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012429 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012430 tcp-request content reject
12431
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012432 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12433 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12434 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12435 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12436 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12437 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12438 ...
12439 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12440
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012441 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012442 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12443 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012444 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012445 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012446
12447 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12448 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012449 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012450 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012451 tcp-request content reject
12452
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012453 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012454 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012455 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012456 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012457 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12458 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012459
12460 Example:
12461 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12462 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012463 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012464
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012465 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012466 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012467
12468 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012469 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012470 # protecting all our sites
12471 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012472 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12473 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012474 ...
12475 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12476
12477 backend http_dynamic
12478 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012479 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012480 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012481 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012482 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012483 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012484 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012486 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012487
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012488 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12489 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012490
12491
12492tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12493 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012495 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012496 Arguments :
12497 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12498 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12499 as explained at the top of this document.
12500
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012501 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012502 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12503 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12504 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12505 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12506
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012507 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12508 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12509 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12510 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12511
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012512 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012513 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012514 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012515 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012516 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012517 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12518 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12519 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012520
12521 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12522 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12523 it pass through unaffected.
12524
12525 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12526 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12527 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012528 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012529 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12530 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012531 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12532 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12533 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012534
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012535 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012536 "timeout client".
12537
12538
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012539tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12540 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12542 no | no | yes | yes
12543 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012544 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12545 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012546
12547 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12548
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012549 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012550 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12551 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012552 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12553 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012554
12555 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12556
12557 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12558 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12559 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12560 inserted.
12561
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012562 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012563 - accept :
12564 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12565 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12566 the rules evaluation.
12567
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012568 - close :
12569 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12570 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12571 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12572 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12573 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12574 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012575 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012576 protocols.
12577
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012578 - reject :
12579 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12580 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012581 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012582
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012583 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012584 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012585
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012586 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12587 Unsets a variable.
12588
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012589 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12590 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12591 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12592 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12593
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012594 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12595 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12596 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12597 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12598
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012599 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12600 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12601 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12602 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12603 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012604
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012605 - "silent-drop" :
12606 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012607 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012608 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12609 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12610 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12611 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12612 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012613 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12614 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012615 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12616 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012617 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012618 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12619 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12620 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12621 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12622
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012623 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12624 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12625
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012626 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12627 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12628 for changing the default action to a reject.
12629
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012630 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12631 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12632 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12633 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012634 period.
12635
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012636 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12637 declared inline.
12638
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012639 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12640 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012641 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012642 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12643 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012644 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012645 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012646 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012647 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12648 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012649 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012650 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12651 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012652
12653 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12654 followed by some converters.
12655
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012656 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12657 <var-name>.
12658
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012659 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12660 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12661 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12662 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12663 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12664
12665 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12666
12667 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12668
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012669 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12670
12671 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12672
12673
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012674tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12675 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12677 no | yes | yes | no
12678 Arguments :
12679 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12680 below.
12681
12682 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12683
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012684 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012685 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12686 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12687 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12688 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12689 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12690 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12691 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012692 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012693 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12694 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12695 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12696 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12697 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12698 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12699 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12700 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12701 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12702 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12703 instead.
12704
12705 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12706 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12707 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12708 rules which may be inserted.
12709
12710 Several types of actions are supported :
12711 - accept : the request is accepted
12712 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12713 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12714 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012715 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012716 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012717 - set-dst <expr>
12718 - set-dst-port <expr>
12719 - set-src <expr>
12720 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012721 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012722 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012723 - silent-drop
12724
12725 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12726 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12727 sections for a complete description.
12728
12729 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12730 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12731 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12732
12733 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12734 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12735 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12736 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12737 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12738
12739 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12740 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12741
12742 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12743 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12744 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12745
12746 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12747 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12748 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12749
12750 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12751 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12752 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12753
12754 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12755 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12756 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12757
12758 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12759
12760 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12761
12762
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012763tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12764 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12766 no | no | yes | yes
12767 Arguments :
12768 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12769 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12770 as explained at the top of this document.
12771
12772 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12773
12774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012775timeout check <timeout>
12776 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12777 established.
12778
12779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12780 yes | no | yes | yes
12781 Arguments:
12782 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12783 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12784 as explained at the top of this document.
12785
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012786 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012787 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012788 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012789 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012790 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12791 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12792 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012793
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012794 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012795 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12796
12797 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12798 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012799 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012800
12801 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12802 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12803 forget about it.
12804
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012805 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12806 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012807
12808
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012809timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012810 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12812 yes | yes | yes | no
12813 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012814 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012815 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12816 as explained at the top of this document.
12817
12818 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12819 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12820 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012821 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12822 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12823 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12824 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012825 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12826 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12827 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012828 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012829 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012830 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12831 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012832 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12833 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012834
12835 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12836 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12837 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12838 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012839 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012840 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12841
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012842 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012844
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012845timeout client-fin <timeout>
12846 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12848 yes | yes | yes | no
12849 Arguments :
12850 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12851 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12852 as explained at the top of this document.
12853
12854 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12855 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12856 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12857 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12858 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12859 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12860 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012861 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12862 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12863 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012864
12865 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12866 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12867 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12868
12869 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12870
12871
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012872timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012873 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12875 yes | no | yes | yes
12876 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012877 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012878 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12879 as explained at the top of this document.
12880
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012881 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012882 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012883 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012884 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012885 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12886 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012887
12888 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12889 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12890 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12891 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012892 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012893 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12894
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012895 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012897
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012898timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12899 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12901 yes | yes | yes | yes
12902 Arguments :
12903 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12904 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12905 as explained at the top of this document.
12906
12907 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12908 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12909 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12910 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12911 once the request has started to present itself.
12912
12913 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12914 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12915 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12916 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12917 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12918
12919 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12920 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12921 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12922 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12923
12924 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12925 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012926 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012927 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12928 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012929 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012930
12931 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12932 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12933 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12934 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12935
12936 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12937
12938
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012939timeout http-request <timeout>
12940 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012942 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012943 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012944 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012945 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12946 as explained at the top of this document.
12947
12948 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12949 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12950 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12951 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12952 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12953 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12954 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012955 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12956 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12957 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12958 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012959 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012960 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12961 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012962
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012963 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12964 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12965 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12966 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12967 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012968 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012969
12970 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12971 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012972 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012973 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12974 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12975
12976 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012977 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12978 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12979 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012980
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012981 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012982 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012983
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012984
12985timeout queue <timeout>
12986 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12988 yes | no | yes | yes
12989 Arguments :
12990 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12991 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12992 as explained at the top of this document.
12993
12994 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12995 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12996 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12997 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12998 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12999
13000 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13001 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13002 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13003 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13004
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013005 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013006
13007
13008timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013009 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13011 yes | no | yes | yes
13012 Arguments :
13013 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13014 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13015 as explained at the top of this document.
13016
13017 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13018 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13019 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13020 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13021 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13022 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13023 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13024
13025 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13026 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13027 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13028 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13029 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013030 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013031 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013032 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13033 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013034 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13035 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013036
13037 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13038 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13039 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13040 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013041 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013042 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13043
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013044 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013045
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013046
13047timeout server-fin <timeout>
13048 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13050 yes | no | yes | yes
13051 Arguments :
13052 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13053 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13054 as explained at the top of this document.
13055
13056 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13057 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13058 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13059 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13060 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13061 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13062 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13063 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13064 situations, it should not be needed.
13065
13066 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13067 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13068 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13069
13070 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13071
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013072
13073timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013074 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13076 yes | yes | yes | yes
13077 Arguments :
13078 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13079 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13080 as explained at the top of this document.
13081
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013082 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13083 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13084 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013085
13086 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13087 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13088 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13089 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013090 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013091
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013092 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013093
13094
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013095timeout tunnel <timeout>
13096 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13098 yes | no | yes | yes
13099 Arguments :
13100 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13101 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13102 as explained at the top of this document.
13103
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013104 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013105 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13106 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13107 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013108 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13109 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013110 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13111 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13112 specified.
13113
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013114 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13115 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13116 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13117 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13118 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13119 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13120 state.
13121
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013122 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13123 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13124 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13125 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013126 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013127
13128 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13129 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13130 forget about it.
13131
13132 Example :
13133 defaults http
13134 option http-server-close
13135 timeout connect 5s
13136 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013137 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013138 timeout server 30s
13139 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13140
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013141 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013142
13143
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013144transparent (deprecated)
13145 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013147 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013148 Arguments : none
13149
13150 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13151 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13152 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13153 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13154 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13155 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13156 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13157 appropriate server.
13158
13159 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13160
13161 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13162 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13163
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013164 See also: "option transparent"
13165
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013166unique-id-format <string>
13167 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13169 yes | yes | yes | no
13170 Arguments :
13171 <string> is a log-format string.
13172
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013173 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13174 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13175 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13176 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013177
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013178 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013179 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013180 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13181 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13182 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13183 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13184 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13185 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013186
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013187 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13188 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013189
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013190 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013191
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013192 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013193
13194 will generate:
13195
13196 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13197
13198 See also: "unique-id-header"
13199
13200unique-id-header <name>
13201 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13203 yes | yes | yes | no
13204 Arguments :
13205 <name> is the name of the header.
13206
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013207 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13208 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013209
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013210 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013211
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013212 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013213 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13214
13215 will generate:
13216
13217 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13218
13219 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013220
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013221use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013222 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13224 no | yes | yes | no
13225 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013226 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13227 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013228
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013229 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13230 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013231
13232 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13233 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13234 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013235 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013236 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013237 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13238 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013239
13240 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13241 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13242 assign the backend.
13243
13244 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13245 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13246 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13247 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13248 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13249 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13250
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013251 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013252 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013253 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13254 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13255 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13256
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013257 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13258 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13259 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13260 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13261 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13262 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13263 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13264 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13265 cannot be forced from the request.
13266
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013267 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013268 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13269 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13270
13271 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13272 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013273
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013274use-fcgi-app <name>
13275 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13277 no | no | yes | yes
13278 Arguments :
13279 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13280
13281 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013282
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013283use-server <server> if <condition>
13284use-server <server> unless <condition>
13285 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13287 no | no | yes | yes
13288 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013289 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13290 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013291
13292 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13293
13294 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13295 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13296 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13297
13298 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13299 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13300 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13301 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13302 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13303 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13304 matches will assign the server.
13305
13306 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13307 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13308 with the next rules until one matches.
13309
13310 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13311 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13312 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13313 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13314
13315 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13316 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13317 stripped.
13318
13319 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13320 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013321 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013322 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013323 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013324
13325 Example :
13326 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013327 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013328 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013329 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013330 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013331 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013332 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013333 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13334 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13335
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013336 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13337 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13338 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13339 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013340 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013341 and we fall back to load balancing.
13342
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013343 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013344
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133465. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013347--------------------------
13348
13349The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13350depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13351settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13352written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13353described in this section.
13354
13355
133565.1. Bind options
13357-----------------
13358
13359The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13360as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13361no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13362parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13363while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13364provided immediately after the setting name.
13365
13366The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13367
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013368accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13369 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13370 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13371 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13372 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13373 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13374 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13375 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13376 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13377 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013378 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13379 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13380 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013381
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013382accept-proxy
13383 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013384 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13385 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013386 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13387 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13388 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13389 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013390 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013391 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13392 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013393 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13394 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013395
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013396allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013397 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013398 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013399 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013400 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13401 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013402
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013403alpn <protocols>
13404 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13405 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13406 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013407 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013408 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013409 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13410 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13411 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13412 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13413 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13414 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13415 preference, like below :
13416
13417 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013418
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013419backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013420 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013421 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13422
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013423curves <curves>
13424 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13425 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13426 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13427 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13428 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13429 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13430
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013431ecdhe <named curve>
13432 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013433 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13434 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013435
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013436ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013437 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13438 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13439 client's certificate.
13440
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013441ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13443 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13444 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13445 error is ignored.
13446
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013447ca-sign-file <cafile>
13448 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13449 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13450 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13451 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13452 'generate-certificates' for details.
13453
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013454ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013455 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13456 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13457 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13458 'generate-certificates' for details.
13459
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013460ca-verify-file <cafile>
13461 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13462 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13463 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13464 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13465 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13466
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013467ciphers <ciphers>
13468 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13469 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013470 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013471 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013472 information and recommendations see e.g.
13473 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13474 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13475 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13476
13477ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13478 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13479 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13480 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13481 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013482 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13483 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013484
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013485crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13487 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013488 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13489 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013490
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013491crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013492 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13493 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13494 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13495 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13496 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013497 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13498 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013499
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013500 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13501 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13502
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013503 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13504 are loaded.
13505
13506 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013507 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13508 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13509 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13510 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13511 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13512 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13513 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013514 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013515
13516 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13517 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13518 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13519 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013520 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13521 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013522
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013523 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013524
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013525 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013526 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013527 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13528 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013529 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13530 clients).
13531
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013532 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013533 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13534 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13535 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13536 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13537 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13538 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13539 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13540 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13541 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13542 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13543 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13544 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13545
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013546 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013547 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13548 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13549 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13550 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13551
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013552 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13553 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13554 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13555 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013556
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013557 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13558 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13559 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013560
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013561crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013562 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013563 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013564 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013565 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013566
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013567crt-list <file>
13568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013569 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13570 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013571
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013572 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13573
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013574 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13575 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13576 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13577 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13578 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013579
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013580 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013581 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13582 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13583 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13584 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13585 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013586 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13587 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13588 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013589
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013590 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13591 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13592 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013593
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013594 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13595
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013596 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013597 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013598 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13599 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13600 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13601 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13602 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13603 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013604
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013605 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013606 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013607 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013608 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013609 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013610 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013611
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013612defer-accept
13613 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13614 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13615 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013616 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013617 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13618 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13619 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13620 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13621 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13622 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13623 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13624
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013625expose-fd listeners
13626 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13627 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013628 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13629 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013630 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013631
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013632force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013633 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013634 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013635 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013636 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013637
13638force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013639 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013640 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013641 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013642
13643force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013644 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013645 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013646 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013647
13648force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013649 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013650 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013651 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013652
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013653force-tlsv13
13654 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13655 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013656 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013657
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013658generate-certificates
13659 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13660 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13661 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13662 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13663 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13664 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13665 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13666 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13667 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13668 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13669 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13670
13671 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13672 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013673 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013674 certificate is used many times.
13675
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013676gid <gid>
13677 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13678 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13679 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13680 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13681 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13682
13683group <group>
13684 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13685 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13686 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13687 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13688 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13689
13690id <id>
13691 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13692 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13693 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13694 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13695
13696interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013697 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13698 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13699 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13700 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13701 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13702 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013703 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13704 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13705 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13706 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13707 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13708 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013709
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013710level <level>
13711 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13712 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13713 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013714 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013715 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13716 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13717 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013718 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013719 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013720 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013721 all counters).
13722
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013723severity-output <format>
13724 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13725 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13726 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13727 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13728 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13729 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13730 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13731 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13732 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13733 rfc5424 convention.
13734
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013735maxconn <maxconn>
13736 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13737 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13738 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13739 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13740 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13741 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13742 eat all memory.
13743
13744mode <mode>
13745 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13746 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13747 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13748 UNIX sockets.
13749
13750mss <maxseg>
13751 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13752 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13753 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13754 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13755 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13756 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13757 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13758 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13759 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13760 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13761 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13762
13763name <name>
13764 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13765 page.
13766
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013767namespace <name>
13768 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13769 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13770 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13771 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13772
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013773nice <nice>
13774 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13775 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13776 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13777 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13778 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13779 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13780 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13781 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13782 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13783 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13784 one for an RDP socket.
13785
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013786no-ca-names
13787 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13788 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013789 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013790
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013791no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013793 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013794 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013795 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013796 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13797 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013798
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013799no-tls-tickets
13800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13801 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13802 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013803 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13804 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013805 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13806 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13807 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013808
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013809no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013811 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013812 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013813 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013814 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13815 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013816
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013817no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013819 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013820 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013821 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013822 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13823 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013824
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013825no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013826 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013827 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013828 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013829 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013830 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13831 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013832
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013833no-tlsv13
13834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13835 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13836 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13837 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013838 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13839 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013840
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013841npn <protocols>
13842 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13843 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13844 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013845 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013846 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013847 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13848 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13849 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13850 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13851 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013852
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013853prefer-client-ciphers
13854 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13855 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13856 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013857 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13858 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13859 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013860
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013861process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013862 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013863 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013864 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013865 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13866 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13867 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13868 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013869 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013870 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13871 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13872 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13873 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13874 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013875
13876 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13877
13878 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13879 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13880 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13881 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13882 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13883 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13884 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13885 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013886
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013887proto <name>
13888 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13889 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13890 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013891 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13892 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13893
13894 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13895 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13896 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13897 also reported (flag=HTX).
13898
13899 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13900 a bind line :
13901
13902 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13903 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13904 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13905
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013906 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013907 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013908 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013909 h2" on the bind line.
13910
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013911ssl
13912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013913 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013914 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13915 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013916 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13917 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013918
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013919ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13920 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013921 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13922 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13923 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013924 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13925
13926ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013927 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13928 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13929 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13930 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013931
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013932strict-sni
13933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13934 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13935 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13936 See the "crt" option for more information.
13937
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013938tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013939 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013940 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013941 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013942 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013943 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13944 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13945 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13946 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13947 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13948 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13949 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13950
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013951tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013952 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013953 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13954 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13955 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13956 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13957 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13958 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13959 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013960 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13961 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13962 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013963
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013964tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13965 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013966 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13967 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13968 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13969 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13970 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13971 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13972 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13973 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13974 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13975 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013976 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13977 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13978
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013979transparent
13980 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13981 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13982 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13983 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13984 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13985 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13986 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13987 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13988 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13989 so check for support with your vendor.
13990
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013991v4v6
13992 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13993 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13994 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13995 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013996 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013997
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013998v6only
13999 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14000 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14001 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014002 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14003 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014004
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014005uid <uid>
14006 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14007 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14008 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14009 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14010 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14011
14012user <user>
14013 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14014 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14015 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14016 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14017 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14018
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014019verify [none|optional|required]
14020 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14021 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14022 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14023 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14024 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014025 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14026 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14027 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14028 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014029
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140305.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014031------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014032
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014033The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14034which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14035arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14036settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14037after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14038Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14039address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014041 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014042 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014043
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014044Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14045keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014047The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014048
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014049addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014050 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014051 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14052 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14053 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14054 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14055 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014056
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014057agent-check
14058 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014059 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014060 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14061 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14062 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014063
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014064 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014065 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014066 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014067 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14068 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014069
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014070 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14071 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14072 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14073 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14074 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014075
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014076 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014077 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014078
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014079 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14080 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14081 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014082
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014083 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14084 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14085 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014086
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014087 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014088 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14089 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14090 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14091 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014092 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014093 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014094
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014095 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14096 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014097
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014098 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14099 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14100 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14101 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14102 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14103 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14104 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14105 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14106 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014107
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014108 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14109 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014110 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14111 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14112 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014113 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014114
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014115 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014116 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014117
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014118agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014119 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014120 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14121 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14122 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14123 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14124
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014125agent-inter <delay>
14126 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14127 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14128
14129 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14130 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14131 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14132 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14133 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14134 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14135 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14136 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14137 of backends use the same servers.
14138
14139 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14140
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014141agent-addr <addr>
14142 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14143
14144 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014145 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014146 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14147 hostname, it will be resolved.
14148
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014149agent-port <port>
14150 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14151
14152 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14153
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014154allow-0rtt
14155 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014156 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14157 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014158
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014159alpn <protocols>
14160 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14161 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14162 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014163 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014164 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14165 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14166 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14167 now obsolete NPN extension.
14168 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14169 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14170
14171 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14172
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014173 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014175backup
14176 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14177 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14178 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14179 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014180 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14181 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014182
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014183ca-file <cafile>
14184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14185 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14186 server's certificate.
14187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014188check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014189 This option enables health checks on a server:
14190 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14191 considered available.
14192 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14193 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14194 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14195 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14196 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14197 set.
14198 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14199 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14200 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14201 exchanges succeed.
14202
14203 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14204 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14205 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14206 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14207 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014208 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014209 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14210
14211 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14212 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14213
14214 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14215 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14216
14217 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14218 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14219 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14220 available.
14221
14222 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14223 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14224 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14225
14226 Example:
14227 # simple tcp check
14228 backend foo
14229 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14230 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14231 backend foo
14232 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14233 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14234 backend foo
14235 option tcp-check
14236 tcp-check connect
14237 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014238
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014239check-send-proxy
14240 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14241 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14242 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14243 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14244 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14245 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14246 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14247
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014248check-alpn <protocols>
14249 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14250 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14251 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14252
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014253check-proto <name>
14254 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14255 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14256 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014257 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14258 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14259
14260 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14261 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14262 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14263 also reported (flag=HTX).
14264
14265 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14266 directive on a server line:
14267
14268 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14269 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14270 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14271 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14272
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014273 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014274 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14275 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14276
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014277check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014278 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014279 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14280 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014281
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014282check-ssl
14283 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14284 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14285 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14286 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014287 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014288 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14289 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014290 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014291 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14292 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014293
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014294check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014295 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014296 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14297 for normal traffic.
14298
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014299ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14301 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14302 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014303 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14304 information and recommendations see e.g.
14305 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14306 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14307 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014308
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014309ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14311 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14312 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14313 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014314 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14315 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14316 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014318cookie <value>
14319 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14320 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14321 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14322 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14323 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14324 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14325 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14326
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014327crl-file <crlfile>
14328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14329 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14330 to verify server's certificate.
14331
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014332crt <cert>
14333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14334 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14335 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14336 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14337 certificate request.
14338
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014339 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14340 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14341 option is set accordingly).
14342
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014343disabled
14344 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14345 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14346 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14347 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14348 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014349 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014350
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014351enabled
14352 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14353 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14354 default value.
14355 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14356 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014358error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014359 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14360 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14361 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014363 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014365fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014366 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14367 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14368 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14369
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014370force-sslv3
14371 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14372 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014373 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014374 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014375
14376force-tlsv10
14377 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014378 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014379 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014380
14381force-tlsv11
14382 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014383 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014384 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014385
14386force-tlsv12
14387 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014388 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014389 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014390
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014391force-tlsv13
14392 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14393 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014394 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014395
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014396id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014397 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14398 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14399 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014400
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014401init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14402 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14403 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014404 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014405 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14406 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14407 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14408 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14409 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14410 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14411 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14412 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14413 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014414 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014415 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14416 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14417 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14418 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14419 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14420 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014421 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014422
14423 Example:
14424 defaults
14425 # never fail on address resolution
14426 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014428inter <delay>
14429fastinter <delay>
14430downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014431 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14432 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14433 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14434 between checks depending on the server state :
14435
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014436 Server state | Interval used
14437 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14438 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14439 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14440 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14441 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14442 or yet unchecked. |
14443 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14444 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14445 | "inter" otherwise.
14446 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014448 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14449 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14450 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14451 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014452 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14453 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14454 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14455 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14456 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014457
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014458log-proto <logproto>
14459 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14460 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14461 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14462 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014464maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014465 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14466 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014467 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14468 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014469 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14470 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14471 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14472 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14473
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014474 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14475 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14476 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14477 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14478 than 50 concurrent requests.
14479
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014480maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014481 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14482 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14483 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14484 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014485 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14486 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14487 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14488 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14489 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14490 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14491 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014492
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014493max-reuse <count>
14494 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14495 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14496 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14497 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14498 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14499 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14500 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14501 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014503minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014504 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14505 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14506 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14507 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14508 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14509 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014510 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014511 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014512
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014513namespace <name>
14514 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14515 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14516 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14517 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14518
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014519no-agent-check
14520 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14521 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14522 default value.
14523 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14524 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14525
14526no-backup
14527 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14528 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14529 default value.
14530 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14531 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14532
14533no-check
14534 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14535 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14536 default value.
14537 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14538 "default-server" "check" setting.
14539
14540no-check-ssl
14541 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14542 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14543 default value.
14544 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14545 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14546
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014547no-send-proxy
14548 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14549 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14550 default value.
14551 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14552 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14553
14554no-send-proxy-v2
14555 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14556 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14557 default value.
14558 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14559 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14560
14561no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14562 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14563 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14564 default value.
14565 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14566 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14567
14568no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14569 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14570 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14571 default value.
14572 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14573 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14574
14575no-ssl
14576 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14577 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14578 default value.
14579 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14580 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14581
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014582 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14583 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14584 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14585
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014586no-ssl-reuse
14587 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14588 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14589 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14590 and for paranoid users.
14591
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014592no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014593 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14594 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014595 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014596
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014597 Supported in default-server: No
14598
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014599no-tls-tickets
14600 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14601 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14602 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014603 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14604 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014605 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14606 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14607 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014608 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014609
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014610no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014611 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014612 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14613 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014614 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14615 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014616 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014617
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014618 Supported in default-server: No
14619
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014620no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014621 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014622 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14623 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014624 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14625 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014626 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014627
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014628 Supported in default-server: No
14629
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014630no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014631 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014632 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14633 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014634 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14635 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014636 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014637
14638 Supported in default-server: No
14639
14640no-tlsv13
14641 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14642 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14643 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14644 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14645 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014646 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014647
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014648 Supported in default-server: No
14649
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014650no-verifyhost
14651 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14652 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14653 default value.
14654 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14655 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014656
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014657no-tfo
14658 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14659 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14660 default value.
14661 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14662 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14663
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014664non-stick
14665 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14666 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14667 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14668
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014669npn <protocols>
14670 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14671 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14672 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014673 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014674 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14675 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14676 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014678observe <mode>
14679 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14680 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14681 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14682 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14683 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14684 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014685 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014686
14687 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14688
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014689on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014690 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14691 Currently, four modes are available:
14692 - fastinter: force fastinter
14693 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14694 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14695 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14696 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14697
14698 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14699
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014700on-marked-down <action>
14701 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14702 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014703 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14704 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14705 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14706 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14707 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14708 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14709 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14710 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014711
14712 Actions are disabled by default
14713
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014714on-marked-up <action>
14715 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14716 Currently one action is available:
14717 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14718 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14719 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14720 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014721 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14722 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014723 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14724 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14725
14726 Actions are disabled by default
14727
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014728pool-low-conn <max>
14729 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14730 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14731 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14732 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14733 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14734 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14735 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14736 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14737 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14738 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014739 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14740 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14741 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14742 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014743
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014744pool-max-conn <max>
14745 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14746 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14747 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14748 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14749 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14750 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14751
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014752pool-purge-delay <delay>
14753 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014754 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014755 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014757port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014758 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014759 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14760 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14761 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14762 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14763 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014764
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014765proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014766 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14767 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14768 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014769 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14770 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14771
14772 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14773 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14774 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14775 also reported (flag=HTX).
14776
14777 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14778 a server line :
14779
14780 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14781 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14782 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14783 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14784
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014785 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014786 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14787
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014788 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014790redir <prefix>
14791 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14792 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14793 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14794 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14795 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14796 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14797 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14798 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014799 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014800 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014801 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14802 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14803 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14804 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14805
14806 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014808rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014809 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14810 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14811 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14812
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014813resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14814 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14815 server.
14816
14817 Available options:
14818
14819 * allow-dup-ip
14820 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14821 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14822 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14823 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14824 For such case, simply enable this option.
14825 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14826
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014827 * ignore-weight
14828 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14829 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14830 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14831
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014832 * prevent-dup-ip
14833 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14834 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14835 same fqdn.
14836 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14837
14838 Example:
14839 backend b_myapp
14840 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14841 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14842 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14843
14844 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14845 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14846 it
14847 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14848 different address
14849
14850 Default value: not set
14851
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014852resolve-prefer <family>
14853 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14854 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14855 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14856 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14857
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014858 Default value: ipv6
14859
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014860 Example:
14861
14862 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014863
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014864resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014865 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014866 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014867 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014868 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14869 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014870 configured network, another address is selected.
14871
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014872 Example:
14873
14874 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014875
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014876resolvers <id>
14877 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14878 hostname.
14879
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014880 Example:
14881
14882 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014883
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014884 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014885
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014886send-proxy
14887 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14888 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14889 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14890 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014891 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14892 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14893 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14894 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014895 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014896 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14897 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14898 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14899 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14900 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014901 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14902 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014903
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014904send-proxy-v2
14905 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14906 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14907 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14908 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014909 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14910 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14911 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14912 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014913
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014914proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014915 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14916 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14917
14918 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14919 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14920 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14921 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14922 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14923 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14924 connection is supported).
14925 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14926 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14927 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14928 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14929 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14930 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14931 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014932
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014933send-proxy-v2-ssl
14934 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14935 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14936 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14937 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14938 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14939 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14940 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014941 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14942 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014943
14944send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14945 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14946 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14947 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14948 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14949 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14950 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14951 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14952 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014953 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14954 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014956slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014957 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14958 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14959 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14960 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14961 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14962 parameters :
14963
14964 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14965 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14966
14967 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14968 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14969 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14970 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14971
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014972 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014973 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14974 seen as failed.
14975
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014976sni <expression>
14977 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14978 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14979 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14980 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014981 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14982 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014983 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014984 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14985 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014986
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014987source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014988source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014989source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014990 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14991 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14992 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14993 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14994
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014995 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14996 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14997 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14998 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14999 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15000 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15001 server.
15002
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015003 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15004 specifying the source address without port(s).
15005
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015006ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015007 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15008 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15009 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15010 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15011 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15012 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015013 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15014 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015015
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015016ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15017 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15018 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15019 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15020
15021ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15022 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15023 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15024 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15025
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015026ssl-reuse
15027 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15028 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15029 default value.
15030 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15031 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15032
15033stick
15034 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15035 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15036 default value.
15037 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15038 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015039
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015040socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015041 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015042 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15043 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15044
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015045tcp-ut <delay>
15046 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015047 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015048 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015049 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015050 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15051 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15052 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15053 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15054 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15055 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15056 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15057 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15058 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15059
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015060tfo
15061 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15062 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15063 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15064 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015065 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015066 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015068track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015069 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15070 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15071 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15072 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015073 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15074
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015075tls-tickets
15076 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15077 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15078 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015079 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15080 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15081 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015082 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015083 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015084
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015085verify [none|required]
15086 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015087 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015088 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15089 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015090 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015091 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15092 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15093 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15094 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15095 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15096 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15097 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15098 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015099
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015100verifyhost <hostname>
15101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015102 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15103 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15104 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15105 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15106 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15107 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15108 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15109 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015111weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015112 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15113 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15114 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015115 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15116 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15117 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15118 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15119 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15120 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015121
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015122ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15123 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15124 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15125 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15126
15127 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15128 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15129 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15130 server ALPN contains it.
15131
15132 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15133 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15134 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15135 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15136
15137 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15138 favor of the ALPN extension.
15139
15140 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015142
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151435.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15144-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015145
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015146HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15147using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015148configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015149This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15150can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15151workload.
15152This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15153resolution at run time.
15154Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15155carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15156
15157
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151585.3.1. Global overview
15159----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015160
15161As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15162different steps of the process life:
15163
15164 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15165 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15166 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15167
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015168 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15169 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015170
15171A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15172 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15173 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15174 resolution to know this new IP.
15175
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015176When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015177HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015178SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15179from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015180will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015181will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015182
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015183A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015184 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015185 first valid response.
15186
15187 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15188 servers return an error.
15189
15190
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151915.3.2. The resolvers section
15192----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015193
15194This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015195HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15196contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015197
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015198When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15199uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15200is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15201answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15202
15203When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015204used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015205
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015206 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15207 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15208 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015209
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015210 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15211 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015212
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015213 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015214 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15215 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015216
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015217For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15218following scenarios are possible:
15219
15220 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15221 ignored
15222
15223 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15224 applied
15225
15226 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15227 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15228
15229 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15230 retries the query with a new type
15231
15232 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15233 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015234
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015235As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015236a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015237<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015238
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015239
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015240resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015241 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015242
15243A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15244
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015245accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015246 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015247 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015248 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15249 by RFC 6891)
15250
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015251 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15252 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15253 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15254 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15255 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15256 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015257
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015258nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15259 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15260 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15261 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15262 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15263 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15264 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15265 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15266 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15267 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015268 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15269
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015270parse-resolv-conf
15271 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15272 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15273 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15274
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015275hold <status> <period>
15276 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15277 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015278 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015279 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015280 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15281 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15282 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15283
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015284 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015285
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015286resolve_retries <nb>
15287 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15288 giving up.
15289 Default value: 3
15290
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015291 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15292 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15293 type.
15294
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015295timeout <event> <time>
15296 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15297 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15298 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015299 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15300 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015301 Default value: 1s
15302 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015303 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015304 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015305 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15306 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15307
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015308 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015309
15310 resolvers mydns
15311 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15312 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015313 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015314 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015315 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015316 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015317 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015318 hold other 30s
15319 hold refused 30s
15320 hold nx 30s
15321 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015322 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015323 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015324
15325
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153266. Cache
15327---------
15328
15329HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15330(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15331RAM.
15332
15333The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15334this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15335
15336If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15337independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15338when we try to allocate a new one.
15339
15340The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15341
15342It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15343"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15344for more details.
15345
15346When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15347replaced by "<CACHE>".
15348
15349
153506.1. Limitation
15351----------------
15352
15353The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15354
15355- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015356- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15357 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15358 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015359- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15360- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015361- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15362 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15363 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015364- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15365 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015366- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15367 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15368 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015369
15370- If the request is not a GET
15371- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15372- If the request contains an Authorization header
15373
15374
153756.2. Setup
15376-----------
15377
15378To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15379the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15380
15381
153826.2.1. Cache section
15383---------------------
15384
15385cache <name>
15386 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15387 size of cache is mandatory.
15388
15389total-max-size <megabytes>
15390 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15391 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15392
15393max-object-size <bytes>
15394 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15395 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15396 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15397
15398max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015399 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015400 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15401 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15402 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15403 default.
15404
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015405process-vary <on/off>
15406 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015407 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15408 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15409 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015410 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015411
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015412max-secondary-entries <number>
15413 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15414 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15415 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15416
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015417
154186.2.2. Proxy section
15419---------------------
15420
15421http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15422 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15423 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15424 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15425 after this one.
15426
15427http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15428 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15429 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15430 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15431 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15432
15433
15434Example:
15435
15436 backend bck1
15437 mode http
15438
15439 http-request cache-use foobar
15440 http-response cache-store foobar
15441 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15442
15443 cache foobar
15444 total-max-size 4
15445 max-age 240
15446
15447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154487. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15449----------------------------------
15450
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015451HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015452client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15453The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15454these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15455but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15456data called patterns.
15457
15458
154597.1. ACL basics
15460---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015461
15462The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15463content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15464from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15465simple :
15466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015468 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015469 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15470 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15473adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015474
15475In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015477 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015478
15479This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15480Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15481and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015482an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15483conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15484as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15485are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015486
15487ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15488'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15489which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15490
15491There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15492performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15495specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15496this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015497methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15498ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015499
15500Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15501 - boolean
15502 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15503 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15504 - string
15505 - data block
15506
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015507Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15508converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15509would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15510The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15511which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15512
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015513Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15514keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15515fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15516which are summarized in the table below :
15517
15518 +---------------------+-----------------+
15519 | Sample or converter | Default |
15520 | output type | matching method |
15521 +---------------------+-----------------+
15522 | boolean | bool |
15523 +---------------------+-----------------+
15524 | integer | int |
15525 +---------------------+-----------------+
15526 | ip | ip |
15527 +---------------------+-----------------+
15528 | string | str |
15529 +---------------------+-----------------+
15530 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15531 +---------------------+-----------------+
15532
15533Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15534matching method, see below.
15535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015536The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15537 - boolean
15538 - integer or integer range
15539 - IP address / network
15540 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15541 - regular expression
15542 - hex block
15543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015544The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15545
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015546 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15547 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015549 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015550 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015551 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015552 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15555read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15556if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15557lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15558will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15559beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015560a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15562exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15563
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015564The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15565parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15566ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15567a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15568check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15569
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015570The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15571socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15572file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15575loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15576
15577 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15578
15579In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15580the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15581case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15582as well.
15583
15584The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15585sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15586do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15587methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15588is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015589obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15591default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15592that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15593string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15594
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015595The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15596By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15597string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15598resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015599server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015600waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015601flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15602function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15605sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15606be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015607
15608 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15609 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15611 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15612 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15613 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015614
15615 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15616 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015617 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015618
15619 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015621
15622 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015624
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015625 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015626 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15627
15628 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15629 binary or string samples.
15630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15632 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15635 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15636 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015638 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15639 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15642 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015644 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15645 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15648 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015649 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15652 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15653 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015654
15655For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15656request, it is possible to do :
15657
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015658 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015659
15660In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15661buffer, one would use the following acl :
15662
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015663 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015664
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015665On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15666possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15667
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015668 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15671criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15672method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15673to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15674criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15675the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015678the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15679For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15682 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15683 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15684 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015685
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015686
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015687The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15688types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15689combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15690brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15691default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 +-------------------------------------------------+
15694 | Input sample type |
15695 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015696 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15698 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15699 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015700 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015701 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015702 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015704 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015706 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015708 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015710 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015712 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015714 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015716 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015718 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015720 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015721 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15722 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15723 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015724
15725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157267.1.1. Matching booleans
15727------------------------
15728
15729In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15730Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15731When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15732that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15733
15734Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15735return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15736"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157397.1.2. Matching integers
15740------------------------
15741
15742Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15743enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15744to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15745
15746Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15747matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15748lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015749
15750For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15751unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15752representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15753
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015754As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15755two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15756instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15757ranges and operators.
15758
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015759For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015760operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15761Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15762of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015764Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015765
15766 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15767 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15768 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15769 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15770 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15771
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015772For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015773
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015774 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015775
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015776This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15777
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015778 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015779
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157817.1.3. Matching strings
15782-----------------------
15783
15784String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15785different forms :
15786
15787 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015788 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015789
15790 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015791 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015792
15793 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15794 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15795
15796 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15797 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15798
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015799 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015800 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15801 matches.
15802
15803 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15804 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15805 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015806
15807String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15808exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15809characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15810string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15811to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015812before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015813
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015814Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15815(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15816Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15817
15818Example:
15819 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15820 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158237.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15824---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015825
15826Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15827they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15828possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15829passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15830the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015831the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15832match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015833
15834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158357.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15836-------------------------------------
15837
15838It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15839not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15840a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15841to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15842digits may be used upper or lower case.
15843
15844Example :
15845 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015846 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015847
15848
158497.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15850---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015851
15852IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15853netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15854within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015855host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015856difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15857at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15858does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15859parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015860
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015861The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15862abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15863
15864 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15865 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15866 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15867 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15868 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15869 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15870 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15871 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15872
15873Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15874192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15875
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015876IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15877Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15878trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15879IPv6 patterns.
15880
15881HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15882following situations :
15883 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15884 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15885 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15886 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15887 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15888 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15889 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15890 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15891 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15892 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894
158957.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15896----------------------------------
15897
15898Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15899combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15900
15901 - AND (implicit)
15902 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15903 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015907 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15910indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015912For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15913"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15914requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15915is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15916
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015917 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015918 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15919 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15920 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921
15922To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15923and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15924
15925 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15926 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15927 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15928 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15929
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015930 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015931 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15932 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15933 use_backend www if host_www
15934
15935It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15936expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15937be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15938the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15939
15940 The following rule :
15941
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015942 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015943 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944
15945 Can also be written that way :
15946
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015947 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948
15949It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15950to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15951simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15952sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15953good use is the following :
15954
15955 With named ACLs :
15956
15957 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15958 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15959 monitor fail if site_dead
15960
15961 With anonymous ACLs :
15962
15963 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15964
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015965See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15966keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967
15968
159697.3. Fetching samples
15970---------------------
15971
15972Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15973against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15974sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15975ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15976of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15977available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15978
15979This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15980Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15981compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15982deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15983
15984The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15985matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15986method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15987indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15988
15989As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15990when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15991mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15992the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15993ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15994
15995Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15996multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15997when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015998incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15999are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016000is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16001all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16002
16003Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16004 - name
16005 - name(arg1)
16006 - name(arg1,arg2)
16007
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016008
160097.3.1. Converters
16010-----------------
16011
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016012Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16013of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16014is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16015was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016016has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016017unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16018
16019These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16020sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16021the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016022support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016023
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016024A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16025support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16026supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16027(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16028bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016030The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016031
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001603251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16033 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16034 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16035 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16036 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16037 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16038
16039 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016040 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16041 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016042 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16043 frontend http-in
16044 bind *:8081
16045 default_backend servers
16046 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16047 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16048
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016049add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016050 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016051 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016052 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16053 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016054 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016055 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16056 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16057 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16058 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016059 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016060 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016061
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016062aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16063 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16064 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16065 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16066 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16067 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16068 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16069
16070 Example:
16071 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16072 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16073
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016074and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016075 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016076 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016077 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16078 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016079 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016080 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16081 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16082 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16083 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016084 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016085 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016086
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016087b64dec
16088 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16089 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016090 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16091 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016092
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016093base64
16094 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016095 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016096 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16097 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016098
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016099bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016100 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016101 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016102 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016103 presence of a flag).
16104
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016105bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16106 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16107 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016108 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016109
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016110concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16111 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16112 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16113 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16114 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16115 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16116 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16117 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16118 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16119 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16120 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016121 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016122 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016123 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16124 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016125
16126 Example:
16127 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16128 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16129 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016130 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016131 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16132
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016133cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016134 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16135 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016136
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016137crc32([<avalanche>])
16138 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16139 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16140 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16141 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16142 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16143 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16144 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16145 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16146 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16147 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016148 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16149
16150crc32c([<avalanche>])
16151 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16152 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16153 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16154 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16155 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16156 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16157 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16158 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016159
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016160cut_crlf
16161 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16162 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16163 updated.
16164
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016165da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016166 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16167 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16168 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16169 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016170 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016171 configuration language.
16172
16173 Example:
16174 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016175 bind *:8881
16176 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016177 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016178
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016179debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16180 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16181 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16182 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16183 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16184 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16185 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16186 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16187 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16188 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16189 printable sample types.
16190
16191 Example:
16192 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016193
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016194digest(<algorithm>)
16195 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16196 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16197
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016198 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016199 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16200
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016201div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016202 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16203 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016204 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016205 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16206 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016207 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016208 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16209 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16210 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16211 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016212 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016213 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016214
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016215djb2([<avalanche>])
16216 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16217 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16218 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16219 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16220 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16221 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16222 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016223 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16224 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016225
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016226even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016227 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016228 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16229
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016230field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16231 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16232 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16233 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16234 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16235 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16236 fields.
16237
16238 Example :
16239 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16240 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16241 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16242 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16243 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016244
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016245fix_is_valid
16246 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16247 Information eXchange):
16248
16249 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16250 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016251 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016252 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016253 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016254 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16255 checksum
16256
16257 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16258 the server can be parsed.
16259
16260 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16261 message, false if not.
16262
16263 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16264
16265 Example:
16266 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16267 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16268
16269fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16270 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16271 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16272 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16273 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016274 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016275 added.
16276
16277 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16278 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16279 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16280 fix_is_valid converter.
16281
16282 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16283
16284 Example:
16285 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16286 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16287 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16288 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16289 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16290
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016291hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016292 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016293 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016294 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016295 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016296
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016297hex2i
16298 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016299 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016300
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016301htonl
16302 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16303 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16304 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16305 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16306
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016307hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016308 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16309 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16310 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16311 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16312
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016313 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016314 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16315
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016316http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016317 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16318 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016319 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16320 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16321 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16322 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16323 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16324 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16325 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16326 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016327
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016328iif(<true>,<false>)
16329 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16330 string otherwise.
16331
16332 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016333 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016334
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016335in_table(<table>)
16336 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16337 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16338 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016339 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016340 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16341
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016342ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016343 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016344 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016345 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16346 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16347 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16348 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16349 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016350
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016351json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016352 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016353 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016354 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016355 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16356 of errors:
16357 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16358 bytes, ...)
16359 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16360 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16361
16362 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16363 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16364 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16365 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16366 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16367 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016368 - "ascii" : never fails;
16369 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16370 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016371 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016372 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016373 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16374 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16375
16376 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016377 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016378
16379 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016380 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016381 capture request header user-agent len 150
16382 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016383
16384 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16385 GET / HTTP/1.0
16386 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16387
16388 Output log:
16389 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16390
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016391json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16392 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16393 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16394 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16395 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16396
16397 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16398 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16399
16400 Example:
16401 # get a integer value from the request body
16402 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16403 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16404
16405 # get a key with '.' in the name
16406 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16407 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16408
16409 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16410 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16411
16412 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16413 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16414
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016415language(<value>[,<default>])
16416 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16417 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16418 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16419 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16420 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16421 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16422 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16423 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16424 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016425 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016426 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16427 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016428
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016429 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016430
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016431 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16432 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016433
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016434 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16435 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16436 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16437 use_backend spanish if es
16438 use_backend french if fr
16439 use_backend english if en
16440 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016441
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016442length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016443 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16444 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16445 type. The result is of type integer.
16446
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016447lower
16448 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16449 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16450 type. The result is of type string.
16451
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016452ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16453 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16454 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16455 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16456 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16457 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16458 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16459
16460 Example :
16461
16462 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016463 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016464 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16465
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016466ltrim(<chars>)
16467 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16468 representation of the input sample.
16469
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016470map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16471map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16472map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16473 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16474 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16475 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16476 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16477 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16478 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16479 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16480 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016481
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016482 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16483 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16484 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016485
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016486 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016487 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016488
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016489 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16490 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16491 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16492 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016493 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16494 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016495 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16496 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16497 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16498 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16499 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16500 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16501 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16502 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016503 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16504 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16505 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016506 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16507 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16508 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16509 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16510 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016511
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016512 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16513 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16514 the corresponding match text.
16515
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016516 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16517 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16518 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16519 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16520 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016521
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016522 Example :
16523
16524 # this is a comment and is ignored
16525 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16526 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16527 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16528 | | | `---------- value
16529 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16530 | `---------------------------- key
16531 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16532
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016533mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016534 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16535 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016536 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016537 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016538 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016539 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16540 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16541 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16542 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016543 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016544 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016545
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016546mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016547 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16548 <packettype>.
16549 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16550 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16551 from.
16552 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16553 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16554 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16555
16556 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16557 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16558 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16559 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16560
16561 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16562 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16563 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16564 packets only):
16565 17: Session Expiry Interval
16566 33: Receive Maximum
16567 39: Maximum Packet Size
16568 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16569 25: Request Response Information
16570 23: Request Problem Information
16571 21: Authentication Method
16572 22: Authentication Data
16573 18: Will Delay Interval
16574 1: Payload Format Indicator
16575 2: Message Expiry Interval
16576 3: Content Type
16577 8: Response Topic
16578 9: Correlation Data
16579 Not supported yet:
16580 38: User Property
16581
16582 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16583 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16584 packets only):
16585 17: Session Expiry Interval
16586 33: Receive Maximum
16587 36: Maximum QoS
16588 37: Retain Available
16589 39: Maximum Packet Size
16590 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16591 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16592 31: Reason String
16593 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16594 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16595 42: Shared Subscription Available
16596 19: Server Keep Alive
16597 26: Response Information
16598 28: Server Reference
16599 21: Authentication Method
16600 22: Authentication Data
16601 Not supported yet:
16602 38: User Property
16603
16604 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16605 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16606 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16607 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16608
16609 Example:
16610
16611 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16612 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16613 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16614 if data_in_buffer
16615 # do the same as above
16616 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16617 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16618 if data_in_buffer
16619
16620mqtt_is_valid
16621 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16622
16623 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16624 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16625 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16626 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16627
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016628 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16629
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016630 Example:
16631
16632 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016633 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016634
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016635mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016636 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016637 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16638 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016639 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016640 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016641 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016642 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16643 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16644 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16645 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016646 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016647 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016648
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016649nbsrv
16650 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16651 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16652 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16653 map lookup.
16654
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016655neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016656 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16657 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16658 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16659 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016660
16661not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016662 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016663 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016664 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016665 absence of a flag).
16666
16667odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016668 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016669 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16670
16671or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016672 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016673 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016674 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16675 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016676 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016677 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16678 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16679 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16680 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016681 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016682 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016683
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016684protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16685 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16686 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16687 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16688 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16689 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16690 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16691 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16692 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16693 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16694 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16695 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16696
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016697regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016698 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16699 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16700 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16701 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16702 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16703 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16704 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16705 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16706 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016707 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16708 of characters with other ones.
16709
16710 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16711 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16712 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16713 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16714 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16715 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016716
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016717 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016718
16719 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16720 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16721 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016722 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016723
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016724 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16725 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16726
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016727 # capture groups and backreferences
16728 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016729 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016730 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16731
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016732capture-req(<id>)
16733 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16734 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16735
16736 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016737 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16738 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016739
16740capture-res(<id>)
16741 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16742 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16743
16744 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016745 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16746 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016747
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016748rtrim(<chars>)
16749 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16750 of the input sample.
16751
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016752sdbm([<avalanche>])
16753 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16754 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16755 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16756 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16757 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16758 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16759 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016760 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16761 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016762
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016763secure_memcmp(<var>)
16764 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16765 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16766 match.
16767
16768 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16769 performed in constant time.
16770
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016771 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016772 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16773
16774 Example :
16775
16776 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16777 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16778 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16779 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16780
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016781set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016782 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16783 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16784 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016785 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016786 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16787 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016788 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016789 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16790 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016791 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016792 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016793
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016794sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016795 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016796 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16797
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016798sha2([<bits>])
16799 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16800 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16801
16802 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16803 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16804
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016805 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016806 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16807
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016808srv_queue
16809 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16810 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16811 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16812 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16813 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16814
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016815strcmp(<var>)
16816 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16817 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16818 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16819 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16820 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16821 shorter).
16822
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016823 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16824 strings in constant time.
16825
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016826 Example :
16827
16828 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16829 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16830 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16831
16832
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016833sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016834 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16835 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016836 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016837 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16838 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016839 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016840 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16841 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016842 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016843 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16844 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016845 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016846 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016847
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016848table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16849 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16850 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16851 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16852 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16853 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16854 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16855
16856
16857table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16858 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16859 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16860 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16861 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16862 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16863 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16864
16865table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016869 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16870 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16871
16872table_conn_cur(<table>)
16873 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16874 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16875 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16876 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16877 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16878
16879table_conn_rate(<table>)
16880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16883 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16884 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16885
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016886table_gpt0(<table>)
16887 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16888 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16889 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16890 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16891 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16892
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016893table_gpc0(<table>)
16894 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16895 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16896 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16897 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16898 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16899
16900table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16901 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16902 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16903 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16904 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16905 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16906 sample fetch keyword.
16907
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016908table_gpc1(<table>)
16909 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16910 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16911 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16912 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16913 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16914
16915table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16916 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16917 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16918 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16919 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16920 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16921 sample fetch keyword.
16922
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016923table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16924 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16925 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016926 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016927 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16928 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16929
16930table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16931 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16932 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16933 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16934 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16935 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16936 keyword.
16937
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016938table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16939 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16940 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16941 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16942 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16943 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16944
16945table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16946 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16947 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16948 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16949 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16950 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16951 keyword.
16952
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016953table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16954 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16955 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016956 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016957 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16958 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16959
16960table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16961 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16962 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16963 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16964 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16965 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16966 keyword.
16967
16968table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16969 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16970 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016971 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016972 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16973 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16974 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16975 keyword.
16976
16977table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16978 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16979 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016980 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016981 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16982 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16983 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16984 keyword.
16985
16986table_server_id(<table>)
16987 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16988 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16989 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16990 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16991 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16992 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16993
16994table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16995 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16996 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016997 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016998 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16999 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17000 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17001 keyword.
17002
17003table_sess_rate(<table>)
17004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17006 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17007 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17008 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17009 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17010 keyword.
17011
17012table_trackers(<table>)
17013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17016 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17017 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17018 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17019 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17020 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17021 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17022 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17023
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017024ub64dec
17025 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17026 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17027 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17028
17029 Example:
17030 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17031 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17032
17033ub64enc
17034 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17035
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017036upper
17037 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17038 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17039 type. The result is of type string.
17040
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017041url_dec([<in_form>])
17042 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17043 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17044 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17045 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17046 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17047 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017048
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017049url_enc([<enc_type>])
17050 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17051 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17052 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17053 optional argument is here for future changes.
17054
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017055ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017056 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017057 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17058 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17059 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017060 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17061 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17062 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17063 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017064 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017065 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17066 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017067
17068 Example:
17069 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17070 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17071
17072 message Point {
17073 int32 latitude = 1;
17074 int32 longitude = 2;
17075 }
17076
17077 message PPoint {
17078 Point point = 59;
17079 }
17080
17081 message Rectangle {
17082 // One corner of the rectangle.
17083 PPoint lo = 48;
17084 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17085 PPoint hi = 49;
17086 }
17087
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017088 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17089 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17090 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017091
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017092 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17093 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017094 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017095 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17096
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017097 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017098
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017099 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017100
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017101 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17102 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17103 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017104
17105 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17106 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17107 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17108
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017109 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17110 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17111 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017112
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017113
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017114unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017115 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17116 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17117 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17118 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17119 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17120 response),
17121 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17122 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17123 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17124 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17125
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017126utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17127 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17128 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17129 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17130 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17131 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17132 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17133
17134 Example :
17135
17136 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017137 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017138 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17139
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017140word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17141 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17142 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17143 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017144 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017145 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17146 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17147
17148 Example :
17149 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17150 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17151 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17152 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17153 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017154 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017155
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017156wt6([<avalanche>])
17157 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17158 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17159 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17160 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17161 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17162 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17163 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017164 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17165 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017166
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017167xor(<value>)
17168 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017169 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017170 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017171 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017172 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017173 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17174 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017175 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017176 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17177 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017178 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017179 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017180
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017181xxh3([<seed>])
17182 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17183 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17184 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17185 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17186 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17187 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17188 considered as cryptographically secure.
17189
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017190xxh32([<seed>])
17191 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17192 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17193 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17194 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17195 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17196 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17197 as cryptographically secure.
17198
17199xxh64([<seed>])
17200 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17201 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17202 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17203 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17204 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17205 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17206 as cryptographically secure.
17207
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017208
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172097.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017210--------------------------------------------
17211
17212A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17213not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17214"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17215The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17216
17217always_false : boolean
17218 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17219 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17220
17221always_true : boolean
17222 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17223 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17224
17225avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017226 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017227 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17228 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17229 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17230 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17231 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17232 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17233 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17234 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17235 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17236 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17237 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17238 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17239 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017241be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017242 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17243 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17244 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17245 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017246 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17247
17248be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17249 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17250 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17251 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17252 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17253 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017254 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17255 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017256
17257 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17258 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17259 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017261be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17262 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17263 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17264 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017265 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017266 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17267 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017268
17269 Example :
17270 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17271 backend dynamic
17272 mode http
17273 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17274 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017275
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017276bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017277 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17278 of the string.
17279
17280bool(<bool>) : bool
17281 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17282 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017284connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17285 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017286 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017287 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17288 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017289
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017290 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017291 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017292 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17293
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017294 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17295 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017296
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017297 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017298 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017299 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017300 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017301 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017302 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017303 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017304
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017305 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17306 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017307 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017308 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017309
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017310cpu_calls : integer
17311 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17312 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17313 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17314 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17315 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17316 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17317
17318cpu_ns_avg : integer
17319 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17320 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17321 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17322 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17323 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17324 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17325 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17326 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17327 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17328 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17329 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17330
17331cpu_ns_tot : integer
17332 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17333 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17334 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17335 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17336 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17337 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17338 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17339 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17340 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17341 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17342 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17343 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17344 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17345
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017346date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017347 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017348
17349 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17350 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17351 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017352 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17353
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017354 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17355 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17356 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17357 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17358 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17359
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017360 Example :
17361
17362 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17363 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017364
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017365 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17366 # millisecond granularity
17367 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17368
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017369date_us : integer
17370 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17371 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17372 from the same timeval structure.
17373
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017374distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17375 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17376 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17377 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17378 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017379 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017380 list of supported tokens.
17381
17382distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17383 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17384 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17385 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17386 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017387 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017388 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17389 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17390 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17391 supported tokens.
17392
17393 Example :
17394 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17395 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17396 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17397 # send large files to the big farm
17398 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17399
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017400env(<name>) : string
17401 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17402 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17403 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17404 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17405 certain way.
17406
17407 Examples :
17408 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17409 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17410
17411 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017412 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017414fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17415 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017416 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17417 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017418 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17419 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017420 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017421 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17422 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017423
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017424fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17425 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17426 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17427 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017429fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17431 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17432 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17433 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17434 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17435 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17436 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17437 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017438
17439 Example :
17440 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17441 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17442 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17443 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17444 frontend mail
17445 bind :25
17446 mode tcp
17447 maxconn 100
17448 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17449 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17450 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17451 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017452
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017453hostname : string
17454 Returns the system hostname.
17455
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017456int(<integer>) : signed integer
17457 Returns a signed integer.
17458
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017459ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17460 Returns an ipv4.
17461
17462ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17463 Returns an ipv6.
17464
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017465lat_ns_avg : integer
17466 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17467 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17468 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17469 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17470 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17471 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17472 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17473 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17474 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017475 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17476 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17477 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17478 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17479 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17480 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017481
17482lat_ns_tot : integer
17483 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17484 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17485 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17486 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17487 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17488 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17489 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17490 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17491 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017492 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17493 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17494 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17495 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17496 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017497 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17498 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17499 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17500 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17501 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17502 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17503
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017504meth(<method>) : method
17505 Returns a method.
17506
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017507nbproc : integer
17508 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17509 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17510 and debugging purposes.
17511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017512nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17513 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17514 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17515 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017516 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17517 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17518 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017519
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017520prio_class : integer
17521 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17522 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17523 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17524
17525prio_offset : integer
17526 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17527 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17528 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17529 set-priority-offset".
17530
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017531proc : integer
17532 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17533 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17534 debugging purposes.
17535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017536queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017537 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17538 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17539 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017540 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17541 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17542 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17543 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17544 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17545
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017546rand([<range>]) : integer
17547 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17548 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17549 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17550 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17551 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017553srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17554 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17555 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17556 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17557 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17558 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017559 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17560 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17561
17562srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17563 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17564 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17565 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17566 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17567 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17568 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17569 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17570
17571 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17572 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017573
17574srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17575 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17576 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17577 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017578 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017579 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17580 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17581 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17582
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017583srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17584 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17585 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17586 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17587 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17588 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17589 fetch methods.
17590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017591srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17592 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17593 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017594 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017595 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17596 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017597 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017598 overloading servers).
17599
17600 Example :
17601 # Redirect to a separate back
17602 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17603 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17604 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17605
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017606srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017607 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17608 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17609 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17610
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017611srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017612 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17613 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17614 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17615
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017616srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017617 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17618 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17619 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17620
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017621stopping : boolean
17622 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17623 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17624 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17625
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017626str(<string>) : string
17627 Returns a string.
17628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017629table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17630 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17631 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17632
17633table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17634 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17635 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17636 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17637
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017638thread : integer
17639 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17640 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17641 and debugging purposes.
17642
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017643uuid([<version>]) : string
17644 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17645 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17646 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17647
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017648var(<var-name>) : undefined
17649 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017650 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17651 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017652 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017653 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17654 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017655 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017656 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17657 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017658 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017659 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017660
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176617.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017662----------------------------------
17663
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017664The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017665closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17666methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17667sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17668TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017669the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17670counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017671"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17672used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17673can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17674Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17675table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17676tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17677currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017678
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017679bc_dst : ip
17680 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17681 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17682 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17683 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17684
17685bc_dst_port : integer
17686 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017687 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017688
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017689bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017690 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17691 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17692 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17693
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017694bc_src : ip
17695 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017696 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017697 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17698 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17699
17700bc_src_port : integer
17701 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017702 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017704be_id : integer
17705 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017706 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17707 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017708
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017709be_name : string
17710 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017711 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17712 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017713
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017714be_server_timeout : integer
17715 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17716 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17717 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17718
17719be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17720 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17721 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17722 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17723
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017724cur_server_timeout : integer
17725 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17726 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17727 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17728
17729cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17730 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17731 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17732 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017734dst : ip
17735 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17736 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17737 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17738 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017739 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17740 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17741 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17742 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17743 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17744 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017745
17746dst_conn : integer
17747 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17748 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17749 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17750 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17751 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17752 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17753 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17754 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017755
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017756dst_is_local : boolean
17757 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17758 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17759 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17760 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017761 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017762 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17763 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17764 it only once per connection.
17765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017766dst_port : integer
17767 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17768 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17769 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17770 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17771 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17772 an HTTP header.
17773
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017774fc_fackets : integer
17775 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17776 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17777 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17778 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17779
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017780fc_http_major : integer
17781 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17782 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17783 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17784
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017785fc_lost : integer
17786 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17787 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17788 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17789 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17790
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017791fc_pp_authority : string
17792 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17793 if any.
17794
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017795fc_pp_unique_id : string
17796 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17797 if any.
17798
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017799fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17800 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17801 header.
17802
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017803fc_reordering : integer
17804 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17805 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17806 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17807 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17808
17809fc_retrans : integer
17810 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17811 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17812 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17813 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17814
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017815fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17816 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17817 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17818 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17819 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17820 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17821 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17822
17823fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17824 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17825 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17826 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17827 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17828 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17829 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17830
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017831fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017832 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17833 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17834 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17835 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17836
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017837
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017838fc_unacked : integer
17839 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17840 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17841 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17842 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017843
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017844fe_defbe : string
17845 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17846 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017848fe_id : integer
17849 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017850 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017851 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17852
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017853fe_name : string
17854 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17855 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17856 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17857
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017858fe_client_timeout : integer
17859 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17860 current frontend.
17861
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017862sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017863sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17864sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17865sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017866 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17867 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17868 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17869
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017870sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017871sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17872sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17873sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017874 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17875 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17876 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17877
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017878sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017879sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17880sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17881sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017882 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17883 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017884 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17885 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17886 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017887
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017888 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017889 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17890 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017891 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17892 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17893 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017894 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17895 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17896
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017897sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17898sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17899sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17900sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17901 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17902 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17903 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17904 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17905 when a first ACL was verified.
17906
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017907sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017908sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17909sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17910sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017911 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017912 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17913
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017914sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017915sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17916sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17917sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017918 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17919 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17920 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17921
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017922sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017923sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17924sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17925sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017926 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17927 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17928 See also src_conn_rate.
17929
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017930sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017931sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17932sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17933sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017934 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017935 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017936
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017937sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17938sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17939sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17940sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17941 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17942 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17943
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017944sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17945sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17946sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17947sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17948 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17949 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17950
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017951sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017952sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17953sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17954sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017955 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17956 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17957 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017958 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17959 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17960 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017961
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017962sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17963sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17964sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17965sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17966 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17967 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17968 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17969 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17970 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17971 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17972
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017973sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017974sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17975sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17976sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017977 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017978 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17979 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17980
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017981sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017982sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17983sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17984sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017985 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17986 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17987 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17988 src_http_err_rate.
17989
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017990sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17991sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17992sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17993sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17994 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17995 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17996 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17997
17998sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17999sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18000sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18001sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18002 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18003 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18004 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18005 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18006
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018007sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018008sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18009sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18010sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018011 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018012 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18013 src_http_req_cnt.
18014
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018015sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018016sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18017sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18018sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018019 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18020 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18021 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18022 src_http_req_rate.
18023
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018024sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018025sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18026sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18027sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018028 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018029 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18030 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18031 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18032 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018033
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018034 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018035 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18036 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018037 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18038
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018039sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18040sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18041sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18042sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18043 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18044 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18045 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18046 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18047 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18048
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018049sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018050sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18051sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18052sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018053 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18054 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18055 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018056
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018057sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018058sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18059sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18060sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018061 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18062 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18063 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018064
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018065sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018066sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18067sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18068sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018069 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018070 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18071 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18072 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018073 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018074 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18075
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018076sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018077sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18078sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18079sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018080 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18081 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18082 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18083 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18084 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018085 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018086
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018087sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018088sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18089sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18090sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018091 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18092 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18093 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18094
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018095sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018096sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18097sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18098sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018099 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18100 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018101 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018102 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18103 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018104 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18105 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18106 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018108so_id : integer
18109 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18110 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18111 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018112
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018113so_name : string
18114 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18115 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18116 strings instead of integers.
18117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018118src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018119 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018120 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18121 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18122 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018123 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18124 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18125 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018126 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18127 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18128 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18129 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18130 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18131 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18132 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018133
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018134 Example:
18135 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18136 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018138src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18139 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18140 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18141 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018142 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018144src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18145 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18146 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018147 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018148 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018150src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18151 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18152 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18153 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18154 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18155 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18156 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018157
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018158 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018159 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18160 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18161 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18162 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018163 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018164 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18165 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18166
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018167src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18168 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18169 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18170 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18171 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18172 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18173 was verified.
18174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018175src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018176 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018177 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018178 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018179 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018181src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018182 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018183 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18184 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018185 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018187src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18188 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18189 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18190 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018191 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018193src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018194 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018195 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018196 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018197 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018198
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018199src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18200 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18201 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18202 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18203 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18204
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018205src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18206 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18207 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18208 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18209 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018211src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018212 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018213 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018214 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18215 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018216 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18217 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18218 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018219
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018220src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18221 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18222 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18223 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18224 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18225 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18226 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18227 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018229src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018230 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018231 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018232 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018233 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018234 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018236src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18237 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18238 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18239 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18240 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018241 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018242
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018243src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18244 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18245 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018246 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018247 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18248 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18249
18250src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18251 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18252 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18253 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18254 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18255 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18256 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018258src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018259 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018260 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18261 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018262 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018264src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18265 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18266 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18267 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018268 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018269 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018271src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18272 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18273 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18274 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018275 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018276 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18277 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018278
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018279 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018280 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018281 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018282 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018283
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018284src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18285 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18286 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18287 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18288 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18289 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18290 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18291
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018292src_is_local : boolean
18293 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18294 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18295 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18296 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018297 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018298 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18299 once per connection.
18300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018301src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018302 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18303 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18304 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18305 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18306 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018308src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018309 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18310 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18311 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18312 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18313 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018315src_port : integer
18316 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18317 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18318 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18319 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018321src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018322 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018323 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18324 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18325 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018326 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018328src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18329 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18330 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18331 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18332 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018333 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018335src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18336 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18337 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18338 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18339 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18340 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18341 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18342 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18343 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018344
18345 Example :
18346 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18347 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18348 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18349 listen ssh
18350 bind :22
18351 mode tcp
18352 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018353 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018354 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018355 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018357srv_id : integer
18358 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18359 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018360 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018361
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018362srv_name : string
18363 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18364 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018365 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018366
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200183677.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018368----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018369
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018370The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18372when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18373usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018374future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018375
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001837651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18377 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18378 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18379 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18380 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18381 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18382
18383 Example :
18384 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18385 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18386 # the request.
18387 frontend http-in
18388 bind *:8081
18389 default_backend servers
18390 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18391 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18392
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018393ssl_bc : boolean
18394 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18395 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018396 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18397 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018398
18399ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18400 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018401 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18402 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018403
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018404ssl_bc_alpn : string
18405 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18406 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018407 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018408 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18409 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18410 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18411 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18412 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018413 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18414 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018415
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018416ssl_bc_cipher : string
18417 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018418 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18419 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018420
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018421ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18422 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18423 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18424 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018425 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018426
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018427ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18428 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18429 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018430 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18431 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018432
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018433ssl_bc_npn : string
18434 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18435 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018436 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018437 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18438 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18439 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18440 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018441 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18442 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018443
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018444ssl_bc_protocol : string
18445 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018446 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18447 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018448
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018449ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018450 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018451 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018452 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18453 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018454
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018455ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18456 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18457 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18458 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018459 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018460
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018461ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18462 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18463 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018464 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18465 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018466
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018467ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18468 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18469 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18470 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018471 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018472
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018473ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18474 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018475 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18476 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018478ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18479 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18480 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18481 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18482 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18483 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018485ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18486 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18487 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18488 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18489 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018490
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018491ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018492 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18493 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18494 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018495 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018496 does not support resumed sessions.
18497
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018498ssl_c_der : binary
18499 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18500 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18501 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018503ssl_c_err : integer
18504 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18505 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18506 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18507 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18508 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018509
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018510ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018511 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18512 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18513 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18514 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18515 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18516 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18517 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18518 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018519 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18520 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18521 LDAP v3.
18522 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18523 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018525ssl_c_key_alg : string
18526 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18527 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18528 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018530ssl_c_notafter : string
18531 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18532 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18533 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018535ssl_c_notbefore : string
18536 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18537 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18538 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018539
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018540ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018541 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18542 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18543 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18544 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18545 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18546 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18547 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18548 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018549 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18550 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18551 LDAP v3.
18552 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18553 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018555ssl_c_serial : binary
18556 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18557 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18558 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018560ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18561 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18562 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18563 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018564 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18565 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18566
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018567 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018568 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018570ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18571 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18572 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18573 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018575ssl_c_used : boolean
18576 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18577 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018579ssl_c_verify : integer
18580 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18581 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18582 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18583 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018585ssl_c_version : integer
18586 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18587 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018588
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018589ssl_f_der : binary
18590 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18591 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18592 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18593
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018594ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018595 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18596 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18597 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18598 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018599 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018600 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18601 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18602 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018603 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18604 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18605 LDAP v3.
18606 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18607 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018609ssl_f_key_alg : string
18610 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18611 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18612 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018614ssl_f_notafter : string
18615 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18616 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18617 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018619ssl_f_notbefore : string
18620 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18621 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18622 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018623
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018624ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018625 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18626 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18627 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18628 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18629 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18630 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18631 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18632 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018633 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18634 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18635 LDAP v3.
18636 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18637 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018639ssl_f_serial : binary
18640 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18641 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18642 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018643
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018644ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18645 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18646 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18647 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018649ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18650 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18651 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18652 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018654ssl_f_version : integer
18655 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18656 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18657
18658ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018659 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18660 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18661 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018663 Example :
18664 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18665 listen http-https
18666 bind :80
18667 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18668 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18669
18670ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18671 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18672 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18673
18674ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018675 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018676 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018677 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018678 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18679 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18680 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18681 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18682 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18683 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018685ssl_fc_cipher : string
18686 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18687 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018688
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018689ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18690 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18691 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018692 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018693
18694ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18695 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18696 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018697 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018698
18699ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18700 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18701 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18702 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018703 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018704 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018705
18706ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18707 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18708 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018709 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018710
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018711ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18712 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18713 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18714 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18715
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018716ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18717 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18718 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18719 transport layer.
18720 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18721 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18722 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18723 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18724
18725ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18726 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18727 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18728 transport layer.
18729 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18730 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18731 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18732 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18733
18734ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18735 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18736 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18737 transport layer.
18738 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18739 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18740 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18741 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18742
18743ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18744 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18745 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18746 transport layer.
18747 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18748 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18749 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18750 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18751
18752ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18753 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18754 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18755 transport layer.
18756 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18757 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18758 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18759 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018761ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018762 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18763 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018764 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18765 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18766 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18767 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018768
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018769ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18770 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18771 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18772 wait until the handshake happened.
18773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018774ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18775 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018776 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18777 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018778 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018779 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018780
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018781ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018782 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018783 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18784 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018786ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018787 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018788 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018789 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18790 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18791 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18792 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18793 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18794 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018796ssl_fc_protocol : string
18797 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18798 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018799
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018800ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018801 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018802 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018803 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018804
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018805ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18806 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18807 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18808 transport layer.
18809 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18810 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18811 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18812 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18813
18814ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18815 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18816 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18817 transport layer.
18818 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18819 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18820 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18821 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18822
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018823ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18824 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18825 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18826 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018828ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18829 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18830 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18831 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18832 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018833
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018834ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18835 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18836 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18837 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18838 BoringSSL.
18839
18840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018841ssl_fc_sni : string
18842 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18843 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018844 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018845 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18846 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18847
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018848 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018849 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018850 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018851 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018852 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018854 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018855 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18856 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018858ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18859 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18860 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018861
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018862ssl_s_der : binary
18863 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18864 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18865 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18866
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018867ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18868 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18869 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18870 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018871 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018872 does not support resumed sessions.
18873
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018874ssl_s_key_alg : string
18875 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18876 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18877 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18878
18879ssl_s_notafter : string
18880 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18881 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18882 transport layer.
18883
18884ssl_s_notbefore : string
18885 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18886 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18887 transport layer.
18888
18889ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18890 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18891 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18892 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18893 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18894 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18895 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018896 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18897 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018898 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18899 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18900 LDAP v3.
18901 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18902 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18903
18904ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18905 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18906 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18907 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18908 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18909 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18910 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018911 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18912 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018913 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18914 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18915 LDAP v3.
18916 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18917 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18918
18919ssl_s_serial : binary
18920 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18921 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18922 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18923
18924ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18925 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18926 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18927 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18928
18929ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18930 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18931 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18932 layer.
18933
18934ssl_s_version : integer
18935 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18936 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018937
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189387.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018939------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018941Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18942sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18943only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18944For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18945be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18946can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18947sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18948for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18949content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018950
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018951Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18952 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018953 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018954 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18955 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18956 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18957 sample expression). So be careful.
18958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018959payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018960 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018961 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18962 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018964payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18965 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018966 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018967 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018969req.len : integer
18970req_len : integer (deprecated)
18971 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18972 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18973 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18974 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18975 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018976 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018977 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18978 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018980req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18981 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018982 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18983 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18984 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18985 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018986
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018987 ACL derivatives :
18988 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018990req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18991 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18992 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18993 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18994 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018995
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018996 ACL derivatives :
18997 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018999 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019001req.proto_http : boolean
19002req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19003 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19004 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19005 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19006 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19007 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19008 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19009 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019011 Example:
19012 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19013 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19014 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019015 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019017req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19018rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19019 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19020 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19021 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19022 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19023 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19024 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19025 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019027 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19028 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19029 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19030 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19031 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19032 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019034 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019035 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019037 Example :
19038 listen tse-farm
19039 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19040 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19041 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19042 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19043 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19044 persist rdp-cookie
19045 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19046 # This is only useful makes sense if
19047 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19048 stick-table type string size 204800
19049 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19050 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19051 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019053 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019054 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019056req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19057rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19058 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19059 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19060 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19061 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019063 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019064 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019065
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019066req.ssl_alpn : string
19067 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19068 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19069 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19070 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19071 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19072 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019073 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019074
19075 Examples :
19076 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19077 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019078 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019079 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019080 default_backend bk_default
19081
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019082req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19083 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19084 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019085 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19086 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19087 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19088 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19089 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019091req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19092req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19093 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19094 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19095 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19096 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19097 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19098 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19099 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019101req.ssl_sni : string
19102req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19103 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19104 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19105 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19106 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19107 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019108 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19109 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19110 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19111 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19112 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19113 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19114 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19115 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19116 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019118 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019119 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019121 Examples :
19122 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19123 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019124 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019125 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019126 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019127
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019128req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19129 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19130 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19131 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19132 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19133 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19134 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19135 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19136 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19137 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019139req.ssl_ver : integer
19140req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19141 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19142 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19143 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19144 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19145 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19146 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19147 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019148 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019149 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019151 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019152 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019153
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019154res.len : integer
19155 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19156 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19157 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19158 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19159 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019160 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019161 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019162 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019164res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19165 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019166 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019167 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019168 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019169 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019171res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19172 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19173 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19174 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019175 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19176 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019178 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019179
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019180res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19181rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19182 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19183 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19184 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19185 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19186 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19187 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19188 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019190wait_end : boolean
19191 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19192 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019193 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019194 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19195 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019196 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019197 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19198 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019200 Examples :
19201 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19202 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19203 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019205 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19206 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19207 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19208 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19209 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19210 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19211 tcp-request content reject
19212
19213
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192147.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019215--------------------------------------
19216
19217It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19218This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19219data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19220its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19221HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19222content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19223to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19224more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19225response are indexed.
19226
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019227Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19228 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19229 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19230 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19231 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19232 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19233 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019235base : string
19236 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19237 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19238 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19239 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19240 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19241 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19242 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19243 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19244
19245 ACL derivatives :
19246 base : exact string match
19247 base_beg : prefix match
19248 base_dir : subdir match
19249 base_dom : domain match
19250 base_end : suffix match
19251 base_len : length match
19252 base_reg : regex match
19253 base_sub : substring match
19254
19255base32 : integer
19256 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19257 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19258 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019259 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19260 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19261 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019262
19263base32+src : binary
19264 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19265 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19266 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19267 per-URL counters.
19268
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019269baseq : string
19270 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19271 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19272 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19273 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19274
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019275capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19276 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19277 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19278 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19279
19280capture.req.method : string
19281 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19282 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19283 because it's allocated.
19284
19285capture.req.uri : string
19286 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19287 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19288 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19289 allocated.
19290
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019291capture.req.ver : string
19292 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19293 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19294 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19295
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019296capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19297 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19298 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19299 The first entry is an index of 0.
19300 See also: "capture response header"
19301
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019302capture.res.ver : string
19303 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19304 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19305 persistent flag.
19306
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019307req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019308 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19309 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19310 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019311
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019312req.body_param([<name>) : string
19313 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19314 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19315 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19316 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19317 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19318 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19319 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19320 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19321 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19322 given.
19323
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019324req.body_len : integer
19325 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19326 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019327 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19328 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019329
19330req.body_size : integer
19331 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019332 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19333 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019335req.cook([<name>]) : string
19336cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19337 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19338 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19339 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19340 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19341 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19342 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19343 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19344 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19345
19346 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019347 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19348 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19349 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19350 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19351 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19352 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19353 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19354 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019356req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19357cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19358 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19359 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019361req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19362cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19363 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19364 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19365 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19366 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019368cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19369 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19370 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19371 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19372 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019373 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019374 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19375 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19376 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19377 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019379hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19380 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19381 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19382 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19383 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019384 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019386req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019387 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19388 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19389 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19390 with headers such as User-Agent.
19391
19392 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19393 found.
19394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019395 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19396 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19397 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019398 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019400req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19401 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19402 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019403 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19404 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019406req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019407 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19408 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19409 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19410 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19411 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19412 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19413 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19414
19415 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19416 found.
19417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019418 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19419 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19420 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019421 with -1 being the last one.
19422
19423 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19424 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019426 ACL derivatives :
19427 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19428 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19429 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19430 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19431 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19432 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19433 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19434 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19435
19436req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19437hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19438 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19439 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019440 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19441 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19442 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19443
19444 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19445 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19446 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19447
19448 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019449
19450req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19451hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19452 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19453 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19454 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019455 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19456 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19457 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19458 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19459 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019460
19461 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19462
19463 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019464
19465req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19466hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19467 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19468 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19469 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019470
19471 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19472
19473 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019474
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019475req.hdrs : string
19476 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19477 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19478 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19479 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19480
19481req.hdrs_bin : binary
19482 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19483 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19484 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19485 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19486 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19487 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19488
19489 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019490
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019491 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19492 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019494http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19495 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19496 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19497 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19498 basic auth is supported.
19499
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019500http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19501 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19502 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19503 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19504 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019505 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19506 basic auth is supported.
19507
19508 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019509 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19510 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19511 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19512 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019513
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019514http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019515 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19516 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19517 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019518
19519http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019520 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19521 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19522 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019523
19524http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019525 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19526 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19527 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019529http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019530 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19531 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019532 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19533 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019535method : integer + string
19536 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19537 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19538 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19539 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19540 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19541 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19542 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019544 ACL derivatives :
19545 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019547 Example :
19548 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19549 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19550 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019552path : string
19553 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19554 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19555 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19556 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19557 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019558 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019559 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019561 ACL derivatives :
19562 path : exact string match
19563 path_beg : prefix match
19564 path_dir : subdir match
19565 path_dom : domain match
19566 path_end : suffix match
19567 path_len : length match
19568 path_reg : regex match
19569 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019570
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019571pathq : string
19572 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19573 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19574 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19575 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19576 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19577 result in both cases.
19578
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019579query : string
19580 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19581 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19582 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19583 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019584 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019585 which stops before the question mark.
19586
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019587req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19588 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19589 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19590 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19591 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019593req.ver : string
19594req_ver : string (deprecated)
19595 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19596 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19597 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019599 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019600 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019601
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019602res.body : binary
19603 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19604 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019605 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19606
19607 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019608
19609res.body_len : integer
19610 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19611 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019612 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19613
19614 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019615
19616res.body_size : integer
19617 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19618 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19619 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19620 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019621 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19622
19623 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019624
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019625res.cache_hit : boolean
19626 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19627 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19628
19629res.cache_name : string
19630 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19631 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19632 empty string.
19633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019634res.comp : boolean
19635 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19636 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19637 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019639res.comp_algo : string
19640 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19641 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19642 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019644res.cook([<name>]) : string
19645scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19646 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19647 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019648 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19649
19650 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019652 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019653 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019655res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19656scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19657 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19658 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019659 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19660
19661 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019663res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19664scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19665 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19666 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019667 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19668
19669 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019671res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019672 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19673 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19674
19675 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19676 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19677
19678 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19679
19680 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019682res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019683 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19684 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19685
19686 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19687 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19688
19689 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019691res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19692shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019693 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19694 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19695
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019696 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019697 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19698
19699 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019701 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019702 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19703 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19704 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19705 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19706 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19707 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19708 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19709 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019710
19711res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19712shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019713 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19714 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19715
19716 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019717 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019718
19719 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019721res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19722shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019723 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19724 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19725
19726 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19727
19728 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019729
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019730res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19731 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19732 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19733 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019734 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19735
19736 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019738res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19739shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019740 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19741 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19742
19743 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19744
19745 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019746
19747res.hdrs : string
19748 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19749 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19750 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019751 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19752
19753 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019754
19755res.hdrs_bin : binary
19756 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19757 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19758 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19759 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19760 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19761 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19762 (length of 0 for both).
19763
19764 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19765
19766 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19767 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019769res.ver : string
19770resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19771 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019772 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19773
19774 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019776 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019777 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019779set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19780 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19781 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019782 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019783 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019785 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19786 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019788status : integer
19789 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19790 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019791 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19792
19793 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019794
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019795unique-id : string
19796 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19797 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19798 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19799 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19800 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19801 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019803url : string
19804 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19805 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19806 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19807 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19808 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19809 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19810 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019812 ACL derivatives :
19813 url : exact string match
19814 url_beg : prefix match
19815 url_dir : subdir match
19816 url_dom : domain match
19817 url_end : suffix match
19818 url_len : length match
19819 url_reg : regex match
19820 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019822url_ip : ip
19823 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19824 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19825 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19826 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19827 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19828 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19829 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019831url_port : integer
19832 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19833 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19834 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19835 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019836
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019837urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19838url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019839 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19840 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019841 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19842 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19843 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19844 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019845 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19846 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019847 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19848 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019850 ACL derivatives :
19851 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19852 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19853 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19854 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19855 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19856 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19857 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19858 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019859
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019861 Example :
19862 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19863 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19864 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19865 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019866
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019867urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019868 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19869 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19870 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019871
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019872url32 : integer
19873 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19874 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19875 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19876 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19877 is an unsigned integer.
19878
19879url32+src : binary
19880 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19881 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19882 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19883
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019884
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200198857.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019886---------------------------------------
19887
19888This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19889used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19890purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19891There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19892or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19893any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19894for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19895
19896internal.htx.data : integer
19897 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19898 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19899
19900internal.htx.free : integer
19901 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19902 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19903
19904internal.htx.free_data : integer
19905 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19906 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19907
19908internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019909 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19910 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19911 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019912
19913internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19914 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19915 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19916
19917internal.htx.size : integer
19918 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19919 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19920
19921internal.htx.used : integer
19922 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19923 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19924 direction.
19925
19926internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19927 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19928 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19929 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19930 of the special value :
19931 * head : The oldest inserted block
19932 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019933 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019934
19935internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19936 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19937 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19938 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19939 integer or one of the special value :
19940 * head : The oldest inserted block
19941 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019942 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019943
19944internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19945 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19946 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19947 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19948 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19949
19950 * head : The oldest inserted block
19951 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019952 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019953
19954internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19955 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19956 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19957 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19958 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19959
19960 * head : The oldest inserted block
19961 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019962 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019963
19964internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19965 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19966 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19967 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19968 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19969
19970 * head : The oldest inserted block
19971 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019972 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019973
19974internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19975 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19976 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19977 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19978 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19979
19980 * head : The oldest inserted block
19981 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019982 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019983
19984internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19985 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19986 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19987 it returns false.
19988
19989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200199907.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019991---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019993Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19994every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019995order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019997ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019998---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19999FALSE always_false never match
20000HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20001HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20002HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020003HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020004HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20005HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20006HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20007HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20008LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20009METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20010METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20011METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20012METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20013METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20014METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20015METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20016METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20017RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20018REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20019TRUE always_true always match
20020WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20021---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020022
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020023
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200248. Logging
20025----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020026
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020027One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20028provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20029very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20030provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20031state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020032to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020033headers.
20034
20035In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20036about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20037send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20038
20039 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20040 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20041 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20042 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20043 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020044 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020045 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020046
20047The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20048allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20049as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20050while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20051real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20052delay.
20053
20054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200558.1. Log levels
20056---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020057
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020058TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020059source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020060HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20061in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20062track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20063syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20064about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020065
20066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200678.2. Log formats
20068----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020069
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020070HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020071and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20072slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20073options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020074
20075 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20076 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20077 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20078 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20079 extents.
20080
20081 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20082 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20083 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20084 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20085 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20086
20087 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20088 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20089 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20090 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20091 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20092
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020093 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20094 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20095 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20096 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20097
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020098 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20099
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020100Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20101specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20102field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20103servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20104always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20105identifier.
20106
20107Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20108 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20109 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20110 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20111 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20112
20113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201148.2.1. Default log format
20115-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020116
20117This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20118as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20119format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20120
20121 Example :
20122 listen www
20123 mode http
20124 log global
20125 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20126
20127 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20128 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20129 (www/HTTP)
20130
20131 Field Format Extract from the example above
20132 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20133 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20134 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20135 4 'to' to
20136 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20137 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20138
20139Detailed fields description :
20140 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20141 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20142 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20143 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20144 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20145 and processed the connection.
20146 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20147
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020148In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20149"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20150connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20151
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020152It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20153will eventually disappear.
20154
20155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201568.2.2. TCP log format
20157---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020158
20159The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20160is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20161information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20162counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20163emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20164environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20165the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20166sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020167specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20168not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20169fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20170marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020171
20172 Example :
20173 frontend fnt
20174 mode tcp
20175 option tcplog
20176 log global
20177 default_backend bck
20178
20179 backend bck
20180 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20181
20182 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20183 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20184 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20185
20186 Field Format Extract from the example above
20187 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20188 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20189 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20190 4 frontend_name fnt
20191 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20192 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20193 7 bytes_read* 212
20194 8 termination_state --
20195 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20196 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20197
20198Detailed fields description :
20199 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020200 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020201 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20202 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020203 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020204 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020205 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020206
20207 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020208 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20209 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20210 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020211
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020212 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020213 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20214 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020215 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20216 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20217 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20218 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020219
20220 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20221 and processed the connection.
20222
20223 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20224 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20225 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20226 applications.
20227
20228 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20229 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20230 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20231 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20232 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20233
20234 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20235 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20236 See "Timers" below for more details.
20237
20238 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20239 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20240 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20241 "Timers" below for more details.
20242
20243 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020244 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020245 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20246 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20247 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20248 details.
20249
20250 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20251 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20252 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20253 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20254 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20255
20256 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20257 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20258 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20259 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20260 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20261 for more details.
20262
20263 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020264 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020265 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20266 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20267 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020268 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020269
20270 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20271 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20272 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20273 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20274 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20275 caused by a denial of service attack.
20276
20277 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20278 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20279 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20280 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20281 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20282 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20283 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20284 denial of service attack.
20285
20286 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20287 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20288 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20289 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20290 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20291 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20292 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20293 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20294 be processed than on other servers.
20295
20296 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20297 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20298 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20299 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020300 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020301 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20302 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20303 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20304 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20305 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20306 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20307 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20308 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20309
20310 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20311 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20312 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20313 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20314 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20315 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020316 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020317 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20318
20319 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20320 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20321 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20322 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20323 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20324 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020325 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020326 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20327 occurs.
20328
20329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203308.2.3. HTTP log format
20331----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020332
20333The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20334is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20335the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20336are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20337emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20338generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20339"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20340which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020341frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20342is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020343
20344Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20345slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20346with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20347
20348 Example :
20349 frontend http-in
20350 mode http
20351 option httplog
20352 log global
20353 default_backend bck
20354
20355 backend static
20356 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20357
20358 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20359 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20360 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020361 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020362
20363 Field Format Extract from the example above
20364 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20365 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020366 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020367 4 frontend_name http-in
20368 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020369 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020370 7 status_code 200
20371 8 bytes_read* 2750
20372 9 captured_request_cookie -
20373 10 captured_response_cookie -
20374 11 termination_state ----
20375 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20376 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20377 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20378 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20379 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020380
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020381Detailed fields description :
20382 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020383 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020384 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20385 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020386 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020387 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020388 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020389
20390 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020391 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20392 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20393 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020394
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020395 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020396 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020397
20398 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20399 and processed the connection.
20400
20401 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20402 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20403 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20404
20405 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20406 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20407 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20408 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20409 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20410 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20411
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020412 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20413 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20414 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020415 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020416 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20417 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020418 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020419 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020420
20421 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20422 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020423 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020424
20425 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20426 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020427 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20428 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020429
20430 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20431 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20432 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20433 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20434 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020435 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20436 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020437
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020438 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020439 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20440 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20441 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20442 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20443 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20444 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020445 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020446
20447 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020448 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20449 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020450
20451 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20452 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020453 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020454 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20455 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20456 overflowing.
20457
20458 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20459 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20460 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20461 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20462 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20463 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20464 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20465 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20466
20467 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20468 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20469 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20470 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20471 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20472 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20473 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20474 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20475
20476 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20477 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20478 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20479 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20480 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20481 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20482 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20483
20484 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020485 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020486 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20487 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20488 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020489 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020490 system.
20491
20492 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20493 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20494 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20495 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20496 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20497 caused by a denial of service attack.
20498
20499 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20500 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20501 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20502 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20503 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20504 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20505 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20506 denial of service attack.
20507
20508 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20509 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20510 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20511 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20512 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20513 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20514 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20515 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20516 processed than on other servers.
20517
20518 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20519 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20520 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20521 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020522 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020523 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20524 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20525 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20526 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20527 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20528 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20529 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20530 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20531
20532 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20533 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20534 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20535 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20536 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20537 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020538 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020539 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20540
20541 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20542 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20543 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20544 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20545 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20546 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020547 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020548 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20549 occurs.
20550
20551 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20552 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20553 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20554 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20555 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20556 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20557 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20558 cookies" below for more details.
20559
20560 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20561 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20562 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20563 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20564 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20565 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20566 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20567 and cookies" below for more details.
20568
20569 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20570 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20571 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20572 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20573 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20574 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20575 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20576 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20577
20578
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200205798.2.4. Custom log format
20580------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020581
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020582The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020583mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020584
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020585HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020586Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20587separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20588prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20589
20590Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20591variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020592("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020593
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020594If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020595as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020596less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20597the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20598
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020599Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20600"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20601delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20602preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020603
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020604Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20605'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20606https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20607such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20608
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020609Flags are :
20610 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020611 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020612 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20613 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020614
20615 Example:
20616
20617 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20618 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20619
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020620 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20621
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020622At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20623
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020624 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20625 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020626
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020627the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020628
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020629 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20630 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20631 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020632
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020633and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20634
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020635 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20636 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020637
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020638Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20639
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020640 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020641 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020642 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20643 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20644 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020645 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20646 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20647 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020648 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020649 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020650 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020651 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020652 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020653 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20654 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020655 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020656 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020657 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020658 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020659 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020660 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020661 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020662 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20663 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20664 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20665 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20666 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020667 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020668 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020669 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020670 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020671 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020672 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20673 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020674 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20675 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20676 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020677 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020678 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20679 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020680 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020681 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20682 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20683 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020684 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020685 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020686 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20687 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20688 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20689 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020690 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020691 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020692 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020693 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020694 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020695 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020696 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20697 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20698 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020699 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020700 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20701 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020702 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020703 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20704 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020705 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020706 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020707 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020708 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020709
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020710 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020711
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020712
207138.2.5. Error log format
20714-----------------------
20715
20716When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020717protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020718By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20719"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020720will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020721logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20722
20723The format looks like this :
20724
20725 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20726 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20727 Connection error during SSL handshake
20728
20729 Field Format Extract from the example above
20730 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20731 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20732 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20733 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20734 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20735
20736These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20737failures.
20738
20739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207408.3. Advanced logging options
20741-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020742
20743Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20744just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20745options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20746for more information about their usage.
20747
20748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207498.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20750------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020751
20752It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020753HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020754commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20755monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20756ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20757
20758 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20759 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20760 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20761 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20762
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020763 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20764 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020765
20766 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20767 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20768 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20769
20770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207718.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20772----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020773
20774The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20775what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20776or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020777"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020778just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20779log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20780after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20781is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20782with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20783with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20784
20785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207868.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20787------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020788
20789Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20790for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20791"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20792retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20793raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20794a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20795file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20796you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20797"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20798
20799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208008.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20801--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020802
20803Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20804multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20805them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20806"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20807logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20808error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20809and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20810too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20811useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20812alternative.
20813
20814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208158.4. Timing events
20816------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020817
20818Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20819reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20820the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20821frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020822mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20823addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20824
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020825Timings events in HTTP mode:
20826
20827 first request 2nd request
20828 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20829 t tr t tr ...
20830 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20831 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20832 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20833 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020834 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020835 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20836
20837Timings events in TCP mode:
20838
20839 TCP session
20840 |<----------------->|
20841 t t
20842 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20843 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20844 |<------ Tt ------->|
20845
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020846 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020847 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020848 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20849 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20850 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020851 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020852 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20853 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20854 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20855 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020856
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020857 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20858 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20859 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020860 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20861 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20862 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20863 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20864 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20865 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020866
20867 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20868 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20869 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20870 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20871 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20872 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20873 request typed by hand during a test.
20874
20875 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20876 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020877 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020878 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20879 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20880 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20881 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020882
20883 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20884 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20885 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20886 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20887 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20888
20889 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20890 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20891 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20892 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20893 connection never established.
20894
20895 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20896 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20897 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20898 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20899 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20900 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20901 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20902 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20903 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20904 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20905 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20906
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020907 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20908 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20909 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20910 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20911 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20912 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20913
20914 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20915
20916 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20917 "Ta" can never be negative.
20918
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020919 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20920 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020921 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20922 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020923 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020924
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020925 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020926
20927 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020928 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20929 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020930
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020931 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20932 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20933 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20934 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20935 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20936 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20937 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20938 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20939
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020940These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20941protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20942that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020943due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20944"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20945that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020946
20947Most common cases :
20948
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020949 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20950 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20951 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20952 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20953 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020954 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020955 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20956 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20957 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20958 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20959 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020960 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020961
20962 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20963 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20964 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20965 of ms on remote networks.
20966
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020967 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20968 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20969 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020970
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020971 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20972 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020973 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020974 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20975 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20976 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20977 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20978 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20979 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020980
20981Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20982
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020983 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020984 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020985 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020986
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020987 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020988 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20989 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20990
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020991 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020992 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20993 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20994 flags.
20995
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020996 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20997 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020998 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20999 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21000 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21001 the client connection was maintained open.
21002
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021003 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021004 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021005 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021006 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21007
21008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210098.5. Session state at disconnection
21010-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021011
21012TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21013"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
210142-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21015each of which has a special meaning :
21016
21017 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21018 session to terminate :
21019
21020 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21021
21022 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21023 server explicitly refused it.
21024
21025 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21026 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21027 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21028 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021029 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021030
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021031 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021032 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021033
21034 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21035 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21036 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21037 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21038 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21039
21040 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21041 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21042 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21043 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21044 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21045
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021046 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021047 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21048
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021049 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021050 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21051 backup connections when going up.
21052
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021053 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021054
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021055 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21056 send or receive data.
21057
21058 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21059 send or receive data.
21060
21061 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21062 with nothing left in the buffers.
21063
21064 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21065
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021066 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021067 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21068
21069 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21070 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21071 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21072 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21073 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21074
21075 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21076 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21077
21078 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21079 server (HTTP only).
21080
21081 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21082
21083 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21084 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21085 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21086
21087 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21088 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21089 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21090
21091 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21092
21093 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21094 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21095
21096 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21097 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21098 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21099
21100 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21101 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021102 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21103 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021104
21105 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21106 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21107 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21108 another server.
21109
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021110 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021111 server.
21112
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021113 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21114 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21115 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21116 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21117
21118 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21119 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21120 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21121 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21122
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021123 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21124 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21125 "use-server" rule).
21126
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021127 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21128
21129 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21130 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21131
21132 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21133
21134 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21135 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21136 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21137
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021138 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21139 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021140 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021141 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21142 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21143
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021144 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21145
21146 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21147 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21148
21149 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21150
21151 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21152
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021153The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21154was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021155helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21156starvation, attacks, etc...
21157
21158The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21159alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21160easier finding and understanding.
21161
21162 Flags Reason
21163
21164 -- Normal termination.
21165
21166 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021167 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21168 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021169 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21170
21171 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21172 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021173 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21174 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021175 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21176 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021177
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021178 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21179 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021180 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021181
21182 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21183 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21184 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21185
21186 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21187 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21188 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21189 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21190 the server takes too long to respond.
21191
21192 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21193 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21194 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21195 long a time to respond.
21196
21197 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21198 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21199 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021200 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021201 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21202 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021203
21204 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21205 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21206 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21207 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21208 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021209 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021210 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21211 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21212 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21213 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21214 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21215 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21216 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21217 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021218 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021219 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21220 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21221 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021222
21223 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21224 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021225 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21226 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21227 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21228 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021229
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021230 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021231 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21232
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021233 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021234 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21235 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021236 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021237 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21238 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21239
21240 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21241 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21242 503 or 504 here.
21243
21244 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021245 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021246 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21247 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21248 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21249
21250 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21251 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021252 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021253 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021254 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021255
21256 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21257 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21258 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21259 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21260 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21261 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021262 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021263
21264 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21265 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21266 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21267 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21268 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21269 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21270 solution is to fix the application.
21271
21272 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21273 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21274 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21275 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21276 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21277 external attacks.
21278
21279 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021280 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021281 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021282 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21283 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21284
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021285 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21286 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21287 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021288 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021289 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021290
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021291 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21292 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21293 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21294 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021295 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21296 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21297 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21298 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021299 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21300 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21301 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21302 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021303
21304 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21305 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21306 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021307 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21308 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21309 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21310 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021311
21312 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21313 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21314 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21315 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21316
21317 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21318 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21319 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21320 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21321
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021322The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021323persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021324important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21325re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21326
21327 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21328
21329 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21330 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21331 set on a GET request.
21332
21333 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21334 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021335 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021336 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21337
21338 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21339 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21340 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21341
21342 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21343 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21344 already got a cookie.
21345
21346 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21347 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21348 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21349 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21350 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21351
21352 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21353 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21354 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21355
21356 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21357 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21358 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21359
21360 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21361 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21362
21363 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21364 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21365 then advertised in the response.
21366
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213688.6. Non-printable characters
21369-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021370
21371In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21372consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21373converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21374prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21375being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21376escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21377is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21378'}' when logging headers.
21379
21380Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21381issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21382containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21383
21384Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21385the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21386performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21387
21388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213898.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21390---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021391
21392Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21393achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021394section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021395cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21396the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21397the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021398locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021399not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21400user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21401a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21402wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21403
21404 Examples :
21405 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21406 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21407
21408 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21409 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21410
21411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21413---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021414
21415Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21416proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21417the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21418server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21419
21420Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21421response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021422section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021423
21424It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021425time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21426appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021427are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21428and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21429follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21430request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21431in the logs.
21432
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021433As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21434frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21435an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21436
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021437 Example :
21438 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21439 listen proxy-out
21440 mode http
21441 option httplog
21442 option logasap
21443 log global
21444 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21445
21446 # log the name of the virtual server
21447 capture request header Host len 20
21448
21449 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21450 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21451
21452 # log the beginning of the referrer
21453 capture request header Referer len 20
21454
21455 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21456 capture response header Server len 20
21457
21458 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21459 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21460
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021461 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021462 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21463
21464 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21465 capture response header Via len 20
21466
21467 # log the URL location during a redirection
21468 capture response header Location len 20
21469
21470 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21471 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21472 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21473 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21474 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21475
21476 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21477 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21478 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21479 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021480 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021481
21482 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21483 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21484 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21485 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21486 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021487 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021488
21489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214908.9. Examples of logs
21491---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021492
21493These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21494them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21495reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21496
21497 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21498 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21499 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21500
21501 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21502 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21503
21504 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21505 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21506 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21507
21508 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21509 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21510
21511 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21512 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21513 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21514
21515 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021516 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021517 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21518 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21519
21520 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21521 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21522 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21523
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021524 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21525 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21526 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21527 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021528 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021529 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021530
21531 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021532 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021533
21534 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21535 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21536 Nothing was sent to any server.
21537
21538 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21539 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21540
21541 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21542 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021543 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021544 send a 408 return code to the client.
21545
21546 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21547 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21548
21549 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21550 5 seconds ("c----").
21551
21552 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21553 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021554 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021555
21556 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021557 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021558 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21559 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21560 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21561 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21562 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021563
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021564
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200215659. Supported filters
21566--------------------
21567
21568Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21569accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21570unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21571
21572See also : "filter"
21573
215749.1. Trace
21575----------
21576
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021577filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021578
21579 Arguments:
21580 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21581 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21582
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021583 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021584
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021585 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021586 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21587 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21588 amount of the parsed data.
21589
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021590 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021591
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021592This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21593callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21594information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21595filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21596
21597Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21598tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21599a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21600
21601
216029.2. HTTP compression
21603---------------------
21604
21605filter compression
21606
21607The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21608keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021609when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21610fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21611done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21612explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21613filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21614listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21615order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021616
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021617See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21618 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021619
21620
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200216219.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21622--------------------------------------------
21623
21624filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21625
21626 Arguments :
21627
21628 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21629 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21630 parsed.
21631
21632 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21633 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21634 part must be placed in its own scope.
21635
21636The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21637external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021638streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021639exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21640also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21641
21642SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21643the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21644
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021645For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021646"doc/SPOE.txt".
21647
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100216489.4. Cache
21649----------
21650
21651filter cache <name>
21652
21653 Arguments :
21654
21655 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21656
21657The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21658"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021659cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021660other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21661case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21662is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21663filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021664listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21665order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021666
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021667See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21668 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21669
21670
216719.5. Fcgi-app
21672-------------
21673
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021674filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021675
21676 Arguments :
21677
21678 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21679
21680The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21681request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21682reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21683used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21684implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21685used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21686fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21687used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21688order.
21689
21690See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21691 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21692
21693
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100216949.6. OpenTracing
21695----------------
21696
21697The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21698HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21699of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21700Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21701
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021702This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021703
21704The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21705HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21706participates in the work of HAProxy.
21707
21708filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21709
21710 Arguments :
21711
21712 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21713 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21714 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21715 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21716 OpenTracing filters.
21717
21718 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21719 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21720 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21721 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21722 filter must have its own scope defined.
21723
21724More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021725of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021726
21727
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002172810. FastCGI applications
21729-------------------------
21730
21731HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21732feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21733the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21734FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21735servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21736FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21737backend.
21738
21739HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21740application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21741connection.
21742
2174310.1. Setup
21744-----------
21745
2174610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21747--------------------------
21748
21749fcgi-app <name>
21750 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21751 document root must be defined.
21752
21753acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21754 Declare or complete an access list.
21755
21756 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21757 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21758 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21759 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21760 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21761
21762docroot <path>
21763 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21764 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21765 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21766
21767index <script-name>
21768 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21769 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21770 is an optional setting.
21771
21772 Example :
21773 index index.php
21774
21775log-stderr global
21776log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021777 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021778 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21779
21780 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21781 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21782
21783pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21784 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21785 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21786 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21787
21788 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21789 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21790 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21791 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21792
21793 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21794 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21795
21796path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021797 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021798 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21799 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21800 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21801 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21802 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21803 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21804 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021805
21806 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021807 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021808 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21809 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21810 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21811 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021812
21813 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021814 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21815 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021816
21817option get-values
21818no option get-values
21819 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21820
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021821 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021822 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21823
21824 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21825 application will accept.
21826
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021827 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21828 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021829
21830 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021831 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021832 option is disabled.
21833
21834 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21835 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21836 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21837 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21838 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21839 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21840
21841option keep-conn
21842no option keep-conn
21843 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21844 sending a response.
21845
21846 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21847 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21848
21849option max-reqs <reqs>
21850 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21851 accept.
21852
21853 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21854 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21855 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21856 to 1.
21857
21858option mpxs-conns
21859no option mpxs-conns
21860 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21861
21862 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21863 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21864
21865set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21866 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21867 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21868 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21869 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21870
21871 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21872 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21873 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21874
21875 Example :
21876 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21877 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21878
21879 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21880
21881
2188210.1.2. Proxy section
21883---------------------
21884
21885use-fcgi-app <name>
21886 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21887
21888 Arguments :
21889 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21890
21891 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21892 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21893 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21894 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21895 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21896
21897 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21898 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21899 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21900 application are evaluated.
21901
21902
2190310.1.3. Example
21904---------------
21905
21906 frontend front-http
21907 mode http
21908 bind *:80
21909 bind *:
21910
21911 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21912 default_backend back-static
21913
21914 backend back-static
21915 mode http
21916 server www A.B.C.D:80
21917
21918 backend back-dynamic
21919 mode http
21920 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21921 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21922
21923 fcgi-app php-fpm
21924 log-stderr global
21925 option keep-conn
21926
21927 docroot /var/www/my-app
21928 index index.php
21929 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21930
21931
2193210.2. Default parameters
21933------------------------
21934
21935A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21936the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021937script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021938applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21939
21940 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21941 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21942 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21943 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21944 | | |
21945 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21946 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21947 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21948 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21949 | | application. |
21950 | | |
21951 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21952 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21953 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21954 | | |
21955 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21956 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21957 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21958 | | the application's configuration. |
21959 | | |
21960 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21961 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21962 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21963 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21964 | | |
21965 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21966 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21967 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21968 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21969 | | be defined. |
21970 | | |
21971 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21972 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21973 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21974 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21975 | | is not set too. |
21976 | | |
21977 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21978 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21979 | | set. |
21980 | | |
21981 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21982 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21983 | | the request. |
21984 | | |
21985 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21986 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21987 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21988 | | |
21989 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21990 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21991 | | script to process the request. |
21992 | | |
21993 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21994 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21995 | | |
21996 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21997 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21998 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21999 | | |
22000 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22001 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22002 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22003 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22004 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22005 | | |
22006 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22007 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22008 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22009 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22010 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22011 | | side. |
22012 | | |
22013 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22014 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22015 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22016 | | connected to. |
22017 | | |
22018 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22019 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22020 | | |
22021 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022022 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22023 | | current HAProxy version. |
22024 | | |
22025 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022026 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22027 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22028 | | |
22029 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22030
22031
2203210.3. Limitations
22033------------------
22034
22035The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22036way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22037during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22038establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22039application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22040or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22041message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22042these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22043and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22044
22045Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22046request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22047requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22048
22049About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22050into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22051fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22052"http-request" ones.
22053
22054Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22055FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22056processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22057must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22058here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022059
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022060
2206111. Address formats
22062-------------------
22063
22064Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22065address.
22066
22067This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22068The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22069of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22070equivalent is '::'.
22071
22072Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22073is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22074
22075This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22076family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22077
22078Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22079configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22080use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22081'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22082
22083Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22084socket type and the transport method.
22085
22086
2208711.1 Address family prefixes
22088----------------------------
22089
22090'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22091
22092'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22093 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22094 listening.
22095
22096'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22097 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22098 on the statement using this address, a port or
22099 a port range may or must be specified.
22100
22101'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22102 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22103 using this address, a port or a port range
22104 may or must be specified.
22105
22106'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22107 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22108 using this address, a port or a port range
22109 may or must be specified.
22110
22111'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22112 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22113 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22114 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22115 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22116 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22117
22118'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22119 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22120 start by slash '/'.
22121
22122
2212311.2 Socket type prefixes
22124-------------------------
22125
22126Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22127type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22128this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22129This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22130but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22131
22132Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22133instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22134
22135If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22136they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22137report this to the maintainers.
22138
22139'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22140 to "stream"
22141
22142'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22143 to "datagram".
22144
22145
2214611.3 Protocol prefixes
22147----------------------
22148
22149'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22150 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22151 socket type and transport method is forced to
22152 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22153 this address, a port or a port range can or
22154 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22155 of 'stream+ip@'.
22156
22157'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22158 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22159 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22160 statement using this address, a port or port
22161 range can or must be specified.
22162 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22163
22164'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22165 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22166 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22167 statement using this address, a port or port
22168 range can or must be specified.
22169 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22170
22171'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22172 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22173 socket type and transport method is forced to
22174 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22175 this address, a port or a port range can or
22176 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22177 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22178
22179'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22180 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22181 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22182 the statement using this address, a port or
22183 port range can or must be specified.
22184 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22185
22186'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22187 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22188 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22189 the statement using this address, a port or
22190 port range can or must be specified.
22191 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22192
22193'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22194 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22195 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22196
22197'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22198 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22199 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22200
22201In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22202QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022204/*
22205 * Local variables:
22206 * fill-column: 79
22207 * End:
22208 */